]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/gcc.git/blame - gcc/doc/tm.texi
remove conditional compilation of sdb debug info
[thirdparty/gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
CommitLineData
5624e564 1@c Copyright (C) 1988-2015 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
feca2ed3
JW
2@c This is part of the GCC manual.
3@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5@node Target Macros
672a6f42 6@chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
feca2ed3
JW
7@cindex machine description macros
8@cindex target description macros
9@cindex macros, target description
10@cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13includes a C header file conventionally given the name
672a6f42
NB
14@file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17@file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18@file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19@file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
648c546a 20source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
672a6f42
NB
21containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
feca2ed3
JW
25
26@menu
648c546a 27* Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
feca2ed3 28* Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
630d3d5a 29* Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
414c4dc4 30* Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
feca2ed3
JW
31* Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32* Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33* Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34* Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35* Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
6ccde948 36* Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
feca2ed3
JW
37* Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38* Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39* Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
aacd3885 40* Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
feca2ed3
JW
41* Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42* Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
c237e94a 43* Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
feca2ed3 44* Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
6ccde948 45* PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
feca2ed3
JW
46* Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47* Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
b216cd4a 48* Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
9f09b1f2 49* Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
91d231cb 50* Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
feb60f03 51* Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
d604bca3 52* MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
7bb1ad93 53* PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
4185ae53 54* C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
09e881c9 55* Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
feca2ed3
JW
56* Misc:: Everything else.
57@end menu
58
672a6f42 59@node Target Structure
648c546a 60@section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
672a6f42
NB
61@cindex target hooks
62@cindex target functions
63
f6897b10
SS
64@deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
672a6f42
NB
66which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68@file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72@smallexample
73#include "target.h"
74#include "target-def.h"
75
76/* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
91d231cb
JM
78#undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79#define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
672a6f42 80
f6897b10 81struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
672a6f42
NB
82@end smallexample
83@end deftypevar
84
85Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
648c546a 86form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
672a6f42
NB
87``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
648c546a 89@code{targetm} structure.
672a6f42 90
acce4e77
JM
91Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
dd5a833e 94initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
acce4e77
JM
95@file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97@file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
c49a6962
JM
99Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102@file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103@code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104@file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105@code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106@code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107default definition is used.
108
feca2ed3
JW
109@node Driver
110@section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111@cindex driver
112@cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114@c prevent bad page break with this line
115You can control the compilation driver.
116
a2c4f8e0 117@defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
db36994b
RS
118A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
3bd6d4c4
AO
121The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
db36994b
RS
127
128This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 133@end defmac
db36994b 134
a2c4f8e0 135@defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
7816bea0
DJ
136A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137@option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144@samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145everywhere it occurs.
146
147The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 152@end defmac
7816bea0 153
a2c4f8e0 154@defmac CPP_SPEC
a3a15b4d 155A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
161d7b59
JM
156pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
feca2ed3
JW
158
159Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 160@end defmac
feca2ed3 161
a2c4f8e0 162@defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
a9374841 163This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
161d7b59 164than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
a9374841 165@code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
a2c4f8e0 166@end defmac
a9374841 167
a2c4f8e0 168@defmac CC1_SPEC
a3a15b4d 169A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
66519c70
JL
170pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171front ends.
a3a15b4d 172It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
630d3d5a 173for GCC to pass to front ends.
feca2ed3
JW
174
175Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 176@end defmac
feca2ed3 177
a2c4f8e0 178@defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
a3a15b4d 179A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 180pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 181give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
feca2ed3
JW
182
183Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
1d96e5b4
FF
184Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185@code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
161d7b59 186CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 187@end defmac
feca2ed3 188
a2c4f8e0 189@defmac ASM_SPEC
a3a15b4d 190A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 191pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
a3a15b4d 192you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
feca2ed3
JW
193See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 196@end defmac
feca2ed3 197
a2c4f8e0 198@defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
a3a15b4d 199A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
feca2ed3
JW
200run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202an example of this.
203
204Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 205@end defmac
feca2ed3 206
a2c4f8e0 207@defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
4977bab6
ZW
208Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212@option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217see @file{mips.h} for instance.
a2c4f8e0 218@end defmac
4977bab6 219
a2c4f8e0 220@defmac LINK_SPEC
a3a15b4d 221A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
feca2ed3 222pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
a3a15b4d 223give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
feca2ed3
JW
224
225Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 226@end defmac
feca2ed3 227
a2c4f8e0 228@defmac LIB_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
229Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231command given to the linker.
232
233If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 235@end defmac
feca2ed3 236
a2c4f8e0 237@defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
a3a15b4d 238Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
feca2ed3
JW
239how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
a3a15b4d 243If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
630d3d5a 244passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
a2c4f8e0 245@end defmac
feca2ed3 246
328163dc
MA
247@defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249@code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
4ec7afd7
KH
251depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252@option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
328163dc
MA
253targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257@end defmac
258
743eeb5a
AM
259@defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
e927b6ad
RO
262generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
743eeb5a
AM
264static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265@code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266@end defmac
267
268@defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272@code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273@end defmac
274
a2c4f8e0 275@defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
276Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
a2c4f8e0 282@end defmac
feca2ed3 283
a2c4f8e0 284@defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
feca2ed3
JW
285Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
a2c4f8e0 290@end defmac
feca2ed3 291
a2c4f8e0 292@defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
008355a6
AO
293GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296@code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299@code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
a2c4f8e0 300@end defmac
008355a6 301
a2c4f8e0 302@defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
303Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305et al, within sysroot+suffix.
a2c4f8e0 306@end defmac
e7f13528 307
a2c4f8e0 308@defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
73774972
EC
309Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
f4314bb6 311updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
e7f13528 312usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
a2c4f8e0 313@end defmac
e7f13528 314
a2c4f8e0 315@defmac EXTRA_SPECS
feca2ed3
JW
316Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317@file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318@code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322string constant that provides the specification.
323
324Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326@code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
630d3d5a 327related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
feca2ed3
JW
328to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329these definitions.
330
331For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334used.
335
336The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
3ab51846 338@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
339#define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342#define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
3ab51846 343@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
344
345The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346@smallexample
347#undef CPP_SPEC
348#define CPP_SPEC \
349"%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
50d440bc
NC
350%@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351%@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
feca2ed3
JW
352%@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356@end smallexample
357
358while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359@code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361@smallexample
362#undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363#define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 365@end defmac
feca2ed3 366
a2c4f8e0 367@defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
feca2ed3
JW
368Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369@file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
630d3d5a 370the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
a2c4f8e0 371@end defmac
feca2ed3 372
a2c4f8e0 373@defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
bbd7687d
DM
374The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
a2c4f8e0 376@end defmac
bbd7687d 377
d9386123
AP
378@defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380The default value of this macro is empty string.
381@end defmac
382
a2c4f8e0 383@defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
9ec36da5
JL
384A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
bbd7687d
DM
389the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390@code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
a2c4f8e0 391@end defmac
9ec36da5 392
c49a6962
JM
393@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395@end deftypevr
396
a2c4f8e0 397@defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3
JW
398Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405@code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406@xref{Target Fragment}.
a2c4f8e0 407@end defmac
feca2ed3 408
a2c4f8e0 409@defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
05739753 410Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
630d3d5a 411a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
feca2ed3 412indicates an absolute file name.
a2c4f8e0 413@end defmac
feca2ed3 414
a2c4f8e0 415@defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
416If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417@code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
1401cf37 418when the compiler is built as a cross
5505263f 419compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
6b1786aa 420to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
a2c4f8e0 421@end defmac
feca2ed3 422
a2c4f8e0 423@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3 424Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
0d037580 425standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
feca2ed3 426try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
0d037580
DJ
427@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 429@end defmac
feca2ed3 430
656c7a3a
AL
431@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436is built as a cross compiler.
437@end defmac
438
439@defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443@code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444is built as a cross compiler.
445@end defmac
446
a2c4f8e0 447@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
448If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
1401cf37 450compiler is built as a cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 451@end defmac
feca2ed3 452
a2c4f8e0 453@defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
feca2ed3 454If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
1401cf37
MLI
455standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456cross compiler.
a2c4f8e0 457@end defmac
feca2ed3 458
a2c4f8e0 459@defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
e9a25f70 460Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
feca2ed3
JW
461variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463initialize the necessary environment variables.
a2c4f8e0 464@end defmac
feca2ed3 465
a2c4f8e0 466@defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
feca2ed3
JW
467Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
08b2bad2
SB
470comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471@file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
feca2ed3 472
c237e94a
ZW
473Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474replacement.
a2c4f8e0 475@end defmac
feca2ed3 476
08b2bad2
SB
477@defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
e9a25f70
JL
479See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
a2c4f8e0 481@end defmac
e9a25f70 482
a2c4f8e0 483@defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
feca2ed3 484Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
e9a25f70
JL
485for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
08b2bad2
SB
487@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488@code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
feca2ed3 489and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
161d7b59 490and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
feca2ed3
JW
491@code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
e9a25f70 494Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
9f6dc500
HPN
495string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496for C++-only directories,
e9a25f70
JL
497and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499the array with a null element.
500
501The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
4bd0bee9 502if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
9f6dc500 503or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
e9a25f70
JL
504operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
e9a25f70 506For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
feca2ed3 507
3ab51846 508@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
509#define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510@{ \
e9a25f70
JL
511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
feca2ed3 516@}
3ab51846 517@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 518@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
519
520Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522@enumerate
523@item
630d3d5a 524Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
525
526@item
fe037b8a 527The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
ff2ce160 528is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
fe037b8a 529@var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
feca2ed3
JW
530
531@item
532The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534@item
fe037b8a 535The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
ff2ce160 536in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
feca2ed3
JW
537
538@item
ff2ce160 539The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
540
541@item
ff2ce160 542The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
fe037b8a
CD
543
544@item
ff2ce160 545The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 546compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
547@end enumerate
548
549Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551@enumerate
552@item
630d3d5a 553Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
feca2ed3
JW
554
555@item
fe037b8a
CD
556The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557value based on the installed toolchain location.
feca2ed3
JW
558
559@item
560The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
512b62fb 561(or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
feca2ed3
JW
562
563@item
fe037b8a 564The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
ff2ce160 565in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
566
567@item
fe037b8a
CD
568The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570@item
ff2ce160 571The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
fe037b8a 572compiler.
feca2ed3
JW
573
574@item
ff2ce160 575The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 576native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
577
578@item
ff2ce160 579The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
fe037b8a 580native compiler, or we have a target system root.
feca2ed3
JW
581
582@item
fe037b8a
CD
583The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
feca2ed3
JW
586
587@item
fe037b8a
CD
588The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
590@file{/lib/}.
591
592@item
fe037b8a
CD
593The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
595@file{/usr/lib/}.
596@end enumerate
597
598@node Run-time Target
599@section Run-time Target Specification
600@cindex run-time target specification
601@cindex predefined macros
602@cindex target specifications
603
604@c prevent bad page break with this line
605Here are run-time target specifications.
606
a2c4f8e0 607@defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22 608This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
44082375 609built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
1f95326c 610the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
cb60f38d 611@code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
12a41c22
NB
612calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613finished command line option processing your code can use those
614results freely.
3df89291
NB
615
616@code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
d90a95fb 618the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
3df89291
NB
619accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
d90a95fb 621@code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
3df89291 622object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
d90a95fb 623@code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
3df89291
NB
624defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629@code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
e0322d5c
NB
632You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633@code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
ce3649d2 637to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
c219e1da
JDA
638variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639@code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640preprocessing.
a2c4f8e0 641@end defmac
e0322d5c 642
a2c4f8e0 643@defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
12a41c22
NB
644Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645and is used for the target operating system instead.
a2c4f8e0 646@end defmac
12a41c22 647
a2c4f8e0 648@defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
4e2e315f
NB
649Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652it yourself.
a2c4f8e0 653@end defmac
4e2e315f 654
a2c4f8e0 655@deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
75685792
RS
656This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657any target-specific headers.
a2c4f8e0 658@end deftypevar
feca2ed3 659
677f3fa8 660@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
75685792
RS
661This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662Its default setting is 0.
9e3be889 663@end deftypevr
75685792 664
bacf5b96
RS
665@cindex optional hardware or system features
666@cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
677f3fa8 668@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
75685792
RS
669This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673definition does nothing but return true.
674
96e45421
JM
675@var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676@var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679via attributes).
75685792
RS
680@end deftypefn
681
acce4e77 682@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
1f1d5130
MS
683This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
7a241624
JR
687valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688default definition does nothing but return false.
1f1d5130
MS
689
690In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694@end deftypefn
695
acce4e77 696@deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
91ebb981
IS
697Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698@end deftypefn
699
70f42967
SB
700@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702@end deftypefn
703
704@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706@end deftypefn
707
acce4e77 708@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
91ebb981
IS
709If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710@end deftypefn
711
acce4e77 712@deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
91ebb981 713If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
26705988
IS
714@end deftypefn
715
2b7e2984 716@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
74f7912a 717This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
2b7e2984
SE
718but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
74f7912a
JR
721when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
2b7e2984
SE
723@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724@end deftypefn
725
c7b5e395 726@defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
c5387660
JM
727This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728but is only used in the C
c7b5e395
GK
729language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731frontends.
732@end defmac
733
677f3fa8 734@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
feca2ed3 735Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
3020190e
JM
736various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738options are processed once
feca2ed3 739just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
3020190e 740of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
2b0d3573 741options passed explicitly.
feca2ed3 742
3020190e 743This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
a51fa0f4
MM
744options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745@code{optimize} attribute.
3020190e 746@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 747
677f3fa8 748@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7e4aae92
JM
749Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750@end deftypefn
751
4c77620d 752@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
128dc8e2
JM
753Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754@end deftypefn
755
3bd36029
RS
756@defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772is 0.
773@end defmac
774
9193fb05
JM
775@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777@end deftypefn
778
414c4dc4
NC
779@node Per-Function Data
780@section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781@cindex per-function data
782@cindex data structures
783
784If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788when another one comes along.
789
790GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793@code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794to their own specific data.
795
796If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
e2500fed
GK
797@code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799@code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
414c4dc4
NC
800
801One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804function, for level 0.
805
aee96fe9 806Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
414c4dc4
NC
807all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
02f52e19 811@code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
414c4dc4
NC
812the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814longer supported.
815
a2c4f8e0 816@defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
c21cd8b1 817Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
414c4dc4 818is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
c21cd8b1 819The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
820function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821@end defmac
414c4dc4 822
a2c4f8e0
ZW
823@deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827@code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
414c4dc4 829
8a36672b 830@code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
e2500fed 831Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
a9429e29 832GC allocation, including the structure itself.
a2c4f8e0 833@end deftypevar
414c4dc4 834
feca2ed3
JW
835@node Storage Layout
836@section Storage Layout
837@cindex storage layout
838
839Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842@xref{Run-time Target}.
843
a2c4f8e0 844@defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
845Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850macro need not be a constant.
851
852This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
a2c4f8e0 854@end defmac
feca2ed3 855
a2c4f8e0 856@defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
857Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 859@end defmac
feca2ed3 860
a2c4f8e0 861@defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
862Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
c0a6a1ef
BS
864memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
feca2ed3 866macro need not be a constant.
a2c4f8e0 867@end defmac
feca2ed3 868
c0a6a1ef
BS
869@defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873the order of words in memory.
874@end defmac
875
a2c4f8e0 876@defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
feca2ed3
JW
877Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878@code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883multi-word integers.
a2c4f8e0 884@end defmac
feca2ed3 885
a2c4f8e0 886@defmac BITS_PER_WORD
e81dd381
KG
887Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 889@end defmac
feca2ed3 890
a2c4f8e0 891@defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
892Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893@code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 895@end defmac
feca2ed3 896
a2c4f8e0 897@defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
c4336539
PB
898Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
a2c4f8e0 900@end defmac
feca2ed3 901
a2c4f8e0 902@defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
feca2ed3
JW
903Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 906@end defmac
feca2ed3 907
a2c4f8e0 908@defmac POINTER_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
909Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
2465bf76
KG
911you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
a2c4f8e0 913@end defmac
feca2ed3 914
a2c4f8e0 915@defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
4923a230
RS
916A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917@code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921@code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
a2c4f8e0 925@end defmac
feca2ed3 926
a2c4f8e0 927@defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
928A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931scalar type.
932
933On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935@var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938counterparts.
939
940For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945@var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
a2c4f8e0 948@end defmac
feca2ed3 949
ef4bddc2 950@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
cde0f3fd
PB
951Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
952function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
953and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
954change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
955pointer} types.
956
666e3ceb
PB
957@var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
958return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
959@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
960If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
961which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
962then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
963the signedness may be different.
964
5e617be8
AK
965@var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
966
cde0f3fd
PB
967The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
968also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
969if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
61f71b34 970@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 971
a2c4f8e0 972@defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
973Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
974bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
975regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
976size of an integer.
a2c4f8e0 977@end defmac
feca2ed3 978
a2c4f8e0 979@defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
980Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
981stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
982desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
983if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
984this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 985@end defmac
c795bca9 986
a2c4f8e0 987@defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
31cdd499
ZW
988Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
989stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
990is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
991macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
992@code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
a2c4f8e0 993@end defmac
feca2ed3 994
2e3f842f
L
995@defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
996Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
997from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
998to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
999@end defmac
1000
a2c4f8e0 1001@defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3 1002Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
a2c4f8e0 1003@end defmac
feca2ed3 1004
a2c4f8e0 1005@defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
c4f46fde
DD
1006Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1007bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1008just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
a2c4f8e0 1009@end defmac
feca2ed3 1010
6d2b7199
BS
1011@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1012If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1013that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1014@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1015@end deftypevr
1016
95331614
OH
1017@defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1018Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1019provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1020@end defmac
1021
6e4f1168
L
1022@defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1023Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1024not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1025@end defmac
1026
a2c4f8e0 1027@defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
861bb6c1
JL
1028If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1029object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1030nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1031on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
a2c4f8e0 1032@end defmac
861bb6c1 1033
a2c4f8e0 1034@defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
11cf4d18
JJ
1035Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1036machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1037structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1038by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1039@end defmac
feca2ed3 1040
a2c4f8e0 1041@defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
feca2ed3 1042An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
ad9335eb
JJ
1043alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1044@code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1045alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1046field alignment has not been set by the
1047@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
a2c4f8e0 1048@end defmac
feca2ed3 1049
2e3f842f
L
1050@defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1051Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1052to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1053
1054If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1055
1056@c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1057@c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1058@c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1059@c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1060@end defmac
1061
a2c4f8e0 1062@defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1063Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1064Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1065@code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1066the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
11d90e2d
CD
1067
1068On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1069the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
a9243bfc 1070a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
11d90e2d
CD
1071On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1072@samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
a2c4f8e0 1073@end defmac
feca2ed3 1074
a2c4f8e0 1075@defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1076If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
8a198bd2
JW
1077the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1078the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
feca2ed3
JW
1079macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1080
1081If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1082
1083@findex strcpy
1084One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1085make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1086arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1087constants to character arrays can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1088@end defmac
feca2ed3 1089
df8a1d28
JJ
1090@defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1091Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1092some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1093AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1094must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1095
1096If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1097@end defmac
1098
a2c4f8e0 1099@defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
feca2ed3
JW
1100If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1101that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1102@var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1103have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1104align the object.
1105
6b00e42d 1106The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
feca2ed3
JW
1107
1108The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1109constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1110constants can be done inline.
a2c4f8e0 1111@end defmac
feca2ed3 1112
a2c4f8e0 1113@defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
a8d1550a 1114If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
d16790f2
JW
1115the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1116the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1117macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1118
1119If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1120
1121One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1123
64ad7c99 1124If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 1125@end defmac
d16790f2 1126
5aea1e76
UW
1127@deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1128This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1129@var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1130require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1131this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1132the vector element type.
1133@end deftypefn
1134
76fe54f0
L
1135@defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1136If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1137@var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1138and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1139have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1140align the slot.
1141
1142If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1143@var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1144be used.
1145
1146This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1147of all possible modes which the slot may have.
4a6336ad 1148
64ad7c99 1149If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
76fe54f0
L
1150@end defmac
1151
9bfaf89d
JJ
1152@defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1153If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1154variable @var{decl}.
1155
1156If this macro is not defined, then
1157@code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1158is used.
1159
1160One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1161make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
4a6336ad 1162
64ad7c99 1163If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
9bfaf89d
JJ
1164@end defmac
1165
ae58e548
JJ
1166@defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1167If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1168for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1169@var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1170
1171If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1172@end defmac
1173
a2c4f8e0 1174@defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
c771326b 1175Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
feca2ed3
JW
1176empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1177
78d55cc8 1178If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1179@end defmac
feca2ed3 1180
a2c4f8e0 1181@defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
feca2ed3
JW
1182Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1183Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1184
1185If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1186@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1187@end defmac
feca2ed3 1188
a2c4f8e0 1189@defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
1190Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1191if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1192go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
a2c4f8e0 1193@end defmac
feca2ed3 1194
a2c4f8e0 1195@defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
feca2ed3 1196Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
c771326b 1197alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
feca2ed3 1198
8dc65b6e
MM
1199The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1200@code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1201structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1202that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1203that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1204
1205Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1206@code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1207four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1208not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1209
1210An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1211structure.
feca2ed3
JW
1212
1213If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1214a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1215
1216Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
c771326b 1217bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
feca2ed3
JW
1218support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1219@samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1220
c771326b 1221The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
feca2ed3
JW
1222@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1223Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1224
c771326b 1225Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
feca2ed3
JW
1226@code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1227@code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1228
a3a15b4d 1229If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
c771326b 1230bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
feca2ed3
JW
1231what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1232
3ab51846 1233@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1234struct foo1
1235@{
1236 char x;
1237 char :0;
1238 char y;
1239@};
1240
1241struct foo2
1242@{
1243 char x;
1244 int :0;
1245 char y;
1246@};
1247
1248main ()
1249@{
1250 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1251 sizeof (struct foo1));
1252 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1253 sizeof (struct foo2));
1254 exit (0);
1255@}
3ab51846 1256@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
1257
1258If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1259get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1260@end defmac
feca2ed3 1261
a2c4f8e0 1262@defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
f913c102
AO
1263Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1264to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
a2c4f8e0 1265@end defmac
feca2ed3 1266
b5bde9ff 1267@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
13c1cd82
PB
1268When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1269whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1270structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1271the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1272@end deftypefn
1273
b5bde9ff 1274@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
c2a64439
PB
1275This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1276should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1277these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1278
7d0b9a9c 1279The default is @code{false}.
c2a64439
PB
1280@end deftypefn
1281
ef4bddc2 1282@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
d9886a9e
L
1283Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1284be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
9f6dc500 1285
182e515e
AH
1286If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1287mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1288case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1289retain the field's mode.
1290
8d8da227 1291Normally, this is not needed.
d9886a9e 1292@end deftypefn
9f6dc500 1293
a2c4f8e0 1294@defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
0003feb2
VM
1295Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1296by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1297way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
feca2ed3
JW
1298@var{specified}.
1299
1300The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1301the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
a2c4f8e0 1302@end defmac
feca2ed3 1303
a2c4f8e0 1304@defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1305An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1306machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1307this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1308appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1309(DImode)} is assumed.
a2c4f8e0 1310@end defmac
feca2ed3 1311
a2c4f8e0 1312@defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
ef4bddc2 1313If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1314specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1315@code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1316@var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1317@code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1318having its mode specified.
73c8090f
DE
1319
1320You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1321would most commonly define this macro if the
1322@code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
132364-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1324@end defmac
73c8090f 1325
a2c4f8e0 1326@defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
ef4bddc2 1327If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
39403d82
DE
1328specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1329@code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1330
1331You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1332You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1333pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
a2c4f8e0 1334@end defmac
39403d82 1335
ef4bddc2 1336@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1337This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1338of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1339@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1340targets.
1341@end deftypefn
1342
ef4bddc2 1343@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
c7ff6e7a
AK
1344This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1345of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1346@code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1347targets.
1348@end deftypefn
1349
ef4bddc2 1350@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
8a9a2486
JR
1351Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1352The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1353@end deftypefn
1354
9ddb66ef 1355@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
f913c102
AO
1356This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1357@var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1358Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1359unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1360different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1361alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1362bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1363the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1364(iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
6335b0aa 1365another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
f913c102 1366other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
e4850f36
DR
1367
1368When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1369of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1370bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1371and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
8a36672b
JM
1372chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1373size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
e4850f36
DR
1374alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1375
1376If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
8a36672b 1377the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
e4850f36
DR
1378used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1379precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1380may affect its placement.
f913c102
AO
1381@end deftypefn
1382
9ddb66ef 1383@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
9a8ce21f 1384Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
9a8ce21f
JG
1385@end deftypefn
1386
9ddb66ef 1387@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
ab22c1fa
CF
1388Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1389@end deftypefn
1390
e41b2a33
PB
1391@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1392This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1393to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1394For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1395for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1396registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1397usage.
1398@end deftypefn
1399
1400@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1401This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1402that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1403@end deftypefn
1404
9ddb66ef 1405@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
608063c3
JB
1406If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1407uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1408to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1409mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1410the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1411not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1412for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1413return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1414string constant.
f18eca82
ZL
1415
1416Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1417qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1418fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1419is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1420length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1421ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1422@var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1423@var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1424code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1425@code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1426codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1427spaces in your string.
1428
608063c3
JB
1429This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1430name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1431can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1432before mangling.
1433
f18eca82
ZL
1434The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1435appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1436types.
1437@end deftypefn
1438
feca2ed3
JW
1439@node Type Layout
1440@section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1441
1442These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1443basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1444the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1445languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1446
a2c4f8e0 1447@defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1448A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1449target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1450@end defmac
feca2ed3 1451
a2c4f8e0 1452@defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1453A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1454target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1455(If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1456unit.)
a2c4f8e0 1457@end defmac
feca2ed3 1458
a2c4f8e0 1459@defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1460A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1461target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1462@end defmac
feca2ed3 1463
a2c4f8e0 1464@defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1615c261 1465On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
8a36672b 1466@code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1615c261
RK
1467that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1468the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1469value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1470@end defmac
1615c261 1471
a2c4f8e0 1472@defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1473A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1474target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
047c1c92 1475words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
feca2ed3 1476macro must be at least 64.
a2c4f8e0 1477@end defmac
feca2ed3 1478
a2c4f8e0 1479@defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3 1480A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
c294bd99
HPN
1481target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1482@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
a2c4f8e0 1483@end defmac
feca2ed3 1484
a2c4f8e0 1485@defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
3d1ad9e5
JM
1486A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1487C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1488this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
a2c4f8e0 1489@end defmac
68eb4fb9 1490
a2c4f8e0 1491@defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1492A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1493target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
a2c4f8e0 1494@end defmac
feca2ed3 1495
a2c4f8e0 1496@defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1497A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1498target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1499words.
a2c4f8e0 1500@end defmac
feca2ed3 1501
a2c4f8e0 1502@defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1503A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1504the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1505words.
a2c4f8e0 1506@end defmac
feca2ed3 1507
325217ed
CF
1508@defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1510the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511@code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1512@end defmac
1513
1514@defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1516the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518@end defmac
1519
1520@defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1522the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524@end defmac
1525
1526@defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1528the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530@end defmac
1531
1532@defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1534the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1536@end defmac
1537
1538@defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1540the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1542@end defmac
1543
1544@defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1546the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1548@end defmac
1549
1550@defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1552the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553@code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1554@end defmac
1555
cdbf4541
BS
1556@defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1557This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1558hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1559causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1560prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1561uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1562the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1563@end defmac
1564
a2c4f8e0 1565@defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
d57a4b98
RH
1566A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1567assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1568default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1569@code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
a2c4f8e0 1570@end defmac
aaa2e8ef 1571
a2c4f8e0 1572@defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
e9a25f70
JL
1573A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1574supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1575value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1576If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1577is the default.
a2c4f8e0 1578@end defmac
e9a25f70 1579
a2c4f8e0 1580@defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
1581An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1582@code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
630d3d5a
JM
1583always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1584and @option{-funsigned-char}.
a2c4f8e0 1585@end defmac
feca2ed3 1586
221ee7c9
KH
1587@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1588This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1589@code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1590of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
35afa569
KH
1591@code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1592
221ee7c9
KH
1593The default is to return false.
1594@end deftypefn
35afa569 1595
a2c4f8e0 1596@defmac SIZE_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1597A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1598for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1599contents of the string.
1600
1601The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1602spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1603appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1604of the data type names defined in the function
176a96de
HPN
1605@code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1606You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1607compiler to crash on startup.
feca2ed3
JW
1608
1609If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1610int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1611@end defmac
feca2ed3 1612
18dae016
TG
1613@defmac SIZETYPE
1614GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1615@code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1616dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1617the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1618is extracted.
1619
1620The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1621
1622If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1623@end defmac
1624
a2c4f8e0 1625@defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1626A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1627for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1628@code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1629@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1630
1631If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1632@end defmac
feca2ed3 1633
a2c4f8e0 1634@defmac WCHAR_TYPE
feca2ed3
JW
1635A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1636for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1637the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1638information.
1639
1640If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1641@end defmac
feca2ed3 1642
a2c4f8e0 1643@defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
1644A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1645characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1646@code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
a2c4f8e0 1647@end defmac
feca2ed3 1648
a2c4f8e0 1649@defmac WINT_TYPE
1a67c7d3
JL
1650A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1651use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1652@code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1653contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1654information.
1655
1656If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
a2c4f8e0 1657@end defmac
1a67c7d3 1658
a2c4f8e0 1659@defmac INTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1660A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1661can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1662The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1663string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1664
1665If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1666@code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1667much precision as @code{long long int}.
a2c4f8e0 1668@end defmac
b15ad712 1669
a2c4f8e0 1670@defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
b15ad712
JM
1671A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1672can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1673type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1674of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1675
1676If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1677@code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1678unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1679int}.
a2c4f8e0 1680@end defmac
b15ad712 1681
207bf79d
JM
1682@defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1683@defmacx INT8_TYPE
1684@defmacx INT16_TYPE
1685@defmacx INT32_TYPE
1686@defmacx INT64_TYPE
1687@defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1688@defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1689@defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1690@defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1691@defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1692@defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1693@defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1694@defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1695@defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1696@defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1697@defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1698@defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1699@defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1700@defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1701@defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1702@defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1703@defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1704@defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1705@defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1706@defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1707@defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1708@defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1709C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1710@code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1711@code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1712@code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1713@code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1714@code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1715@code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1716@code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1717@code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1718@code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1719
1720If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1721type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1722@code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1723to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1724these macros are null pointers.
1725@end defmac
1726
a2c4f8e0 1727@defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
f3c55c97
AO
1728The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1729that looks like:
1730
3ab51846 1731@smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1732 struct @{
1733 union @{
1734 void (*fn)();
1735 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1736 @};
1737 ptrdiff_t delta;
1738 @};
3ab51846 1739@end smallexample
f3c55c97
AO
1740
1741@noindent
1742The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1743will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1744Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1745always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1746distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1747platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1748that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1749the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1750
1751GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1752this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1753However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1754set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1755bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1756address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1757architecture, you should define this macro to
1758@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1759
1760In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1761in which function addresses are always even, according to
1762@code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1763@code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
a2c4f8e0 1764@end defmac
67231816 1765
a2c4f8e0 1766@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
67231816 1767Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
f282ffb3 1768macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
67231816
RH
1769instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1770function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
f282ffb3 1771data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
67231816
RH
1772pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1773
1774If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1775of words that the function descriptor occupies.
a2c4f8e0 1776@end defmac
a6f5e048 1777
a2c4f8e0 1778@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
a6f5e048
RH
1779By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1780is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1781the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1782when special alignment is necessary. */
a2c4f8e0 1783@end defmac
a6f5e048 1784
a2c4f8e0 1785@defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
a6f5e048
RH
1786There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1787zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1788specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1789of words in each data entry.
a2c4f8e0 1790@end defmac
b2b263e1 1791
feca2ed3
JW
1792@node Registers
1793@section Register Usage
1794@cindex register usage
1795
1796This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1797has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1798
1799The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1800done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1801on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1802For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1803For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1804
1805@menu
6ccde948
RW
1806* Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1807* Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1808* Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1809* Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1810* Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
feca2ed3
JW
1811@end menu
1812
1813@node Register Basics
1814@subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1815
1816@c prevent bad page break with this line
1817Registers have various characteristics.
1818
a2c4f8e0 1819@defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
feca2ed3
JW
1820Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1821numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1822pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1823@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 1824@end defmac
feca2ed3 1825
a2c4f8e0 1826@defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1827@cindex fixed register
1828An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1829all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1830general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1831pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1832register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1833machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1834and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1835
1836This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1837commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1838register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1839
1840The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1841the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1842by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
630d3d5a
JM
1843the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1844@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
a2c4f8e0 1845@end defmac
feca2ed3 1846
a2c4f8e0 1847@defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
feca2ed3
JW
1848@cindex call-used register
1849@cindex call-clobbered register
1850@cindex call-saved register
1851Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1852clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1853registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1854available for general allocation of values that must live across
1855function calls.
1856
1857If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1858automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1859exit, if the register is used within the function.
a2c4f8e0 1860@end defmac
feca2ed3 1861
a2c4f8e0 1862@defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
fc1296b7
AM
1863@cindex call-used register
1864@cindex call-clobbered register
1865@cindex call-saved register
f282ffb3
JM
1866Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1867that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
fc1296b7 1868(@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
f282ffb3 1869This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
fc1296b7 1870of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 1871@end defmac
fc1296b7 1872
a2c4f8e0 1873@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1e326708
MH
1874@cindex call-used register
1875@cindex call-clobbered register
1876@cindex call-saved register
df2a54e9 1877A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1e326708
MH
1878value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1879call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1880macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1881preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
a2c4f8e0 1882@end defmac
1e326708 1883
feca2ed3
JW
1884@findex fixed_regs
1885@findex call_used_regs
a2c4f8e0
ZW
1886@findex global_regs
1887@findex reg_names
1888@findex reg_class_contents
5efd84c5
NF
1889@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1890This hook may conditionally modify five variables
055177dc 1891@code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
c237e94a
ZW
1892@code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1893any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1894of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1895@code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1896@code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1897called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1898@code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
055177dc 1899from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
c237e94a 1900@code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
630d3d5a 1901@code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
c237e94a
ZW
1902@option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1903command options have been applied.
feca2ed3 1904
feca2ed3
JW
1905@cindex disabling certain registers
1906@cindex controlling register usage
1907If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1908flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1909@code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
b48e9677
RS
1910registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1911@code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1912that shouldn't be used.
feca2ed3
JW
1913
1914(However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1915of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1916controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1917these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
5efd84c5 1918@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 1919
a2c4f8e0 1920@defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
feca2ed3
JW
1921Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1922expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1923corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1924function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1925outbound register.
a2c4f8e0 1926@end defmac
feca2ed3 1927
a2c4f8e0 1928@defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
feca2ed3
JW
1929Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1930expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1931corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1932function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1933register.
a2c4f8e0 1934@end defmac
feca2ed3 1935
a2c4f8e0 1936@defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
fa80e43d
JL
1937Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1938expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1939register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1940need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1941gotos.
a2c4f8e0 1942@end defmac
fa80e43d 1943
a2c4f8e0 1944@defmac PC_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
1945If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1946register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
a2c4f8e0 1947@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
1948
1949@node Allocation Order
1950@subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1951@cindex order of register allocation
1952@cindex register allocation order
1953
1954@c prevent bad page break with this line
1955Registers are allocated in order.
1956
a2c4f8e0 1957@defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3 1958If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
a3a15b4d 1959numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
feca2ed3
JW
1960to use them (from most preferred to least).
1961
1962If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1963(all else being equal).
1964
1965One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1966registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1967instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1968machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
956d6950 1969the highest numbered allocable register first.
a2c4f8e0 1970@end defmac
feca2ed3 1971
5a733826 1972@defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
feca2ed3
JW
1973A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1974hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1975
1976Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1977Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1978register; and so on.
1979
1980The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1981@code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1982
1983On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 1984@end defmac
feca2ed3 1985
5a733826
BS
1986@defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1987Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1988prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1989using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1990allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
ed15c598
KC
1991call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1992macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
5a733826
BS
1993@end defmac
1994
058e97ec
VM
1995@defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1996In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1997Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1998If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1999based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2000be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2001value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2002to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2003
2004On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005@end defmac
2006
feca2ed3
JW
2007@node Values in Registers
2008@subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2009
2010This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2011(specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2012consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2013
a2c4f8e0 2014@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2015A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2016at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
79e168da
DD
2017@var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2018cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2019and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
feca2ed3
JW
2020
2021On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2022definition of this macro is
2023
2024@smallexample
2025#define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2026 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
32bd3974 2027 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
feca2ed3 2028@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2029@end defmac
feca2ed3 2030
8521c414
JM
2031@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2033in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2034in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2035multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2036this mode by the number of registers returned by
2037@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2038
2039For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2040registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2041nonzero.
2042
2043This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
f1f4e530 2044@code{subreg_get_info}
8521c414
JM
2045would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2046represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2047@code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2048registers and so not be representable.
2049@end defmac
2050
2051@defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2052For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2053@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2054returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2055including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2056@end defmac
2057
ca0b6e3b
EB
2058@defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2059Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2060of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2061should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2062used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2063happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2064floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2065@end defmac
2066
a2c4f8e0 2067@defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2068A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2069of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2070registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2071are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2072
2073@smallexample
2074#define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2075@end smallexample
2076
e9a25f70
JL
2077You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2078because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
feca2ed3
JW
2079
2080@cindex register pairs
2081On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
e9a25f70
JL
2082register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2083odd register numbers for such modes.
feca2ed3
JW
2084
2085The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2086@samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
e9a25f70
JL
2087register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2088value into the register and back out not alter it.
feca2ed3 2089
e9a25f70
JL
2090Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2091all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
feca2ed3
JW
2092@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2093you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2094is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2095and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2096to be tieable.
2097
2098Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2099Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2100in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2101can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2102mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2103registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2104
2105On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2106modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2107registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2108non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2109@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2110floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2111normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2112unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2113register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2114
2115The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2116they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2117instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2118@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2119constraints for those instructions.
2120
2121On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2122so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2123register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2124floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2125be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
a2c4f8e0 2126@end defmac
feca2ed3 2127
150c9fe8
KH
2128@defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2129A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2130@var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2131
2132One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2133another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2134handler.
2135
2136The default is always nonzero.
2137@end defmac
2138
a2c4f8e0 2139@defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
e9a25f70 2140A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
956d6950 2141@var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
feca2ed3
JW
2142
2143If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
e9a25f70
JL
2144@code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2145any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2146should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2147this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
956d6950 2148accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
e9a25f70
JL
2149
2150You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
a3a15b4d 2151possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
e9a25f70 2152allocation.
a2c4f8e0 2153@end defmac
7506f491 2154
dbc42c44
AS
2155@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2156This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2157@var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2158
2159One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2160is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2161
2162The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2163@end deftypefn
2164
a2c4f8e0 2165@defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
7506f491 2166Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
a89608cb 2167registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
7506f491 2168@code{CCmode} is incomplete.
a2c4f8e0 2169@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
2170
2171@node Leaf Functions
2172@subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2173
2174@cindex leaf functions
2175@cindex functions, leaf
2176On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2177more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2178means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2179are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2180normally arrive.
2181
2182The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2183other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2184registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2185function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2186handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2187functions''.
2188
a3a15b4d 2189GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
feca2ed3
JW
2190suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2191registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2192accomplish this.
2193
a2c4f8e0 2194@defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
7d167afd 2195Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
feca2ed3
JW
2196contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2197function treatment.
2198
2199If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2200registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
a3a15b4d 2201GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
feca2ed3
JW
2202used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2203in this vector.
2204
2205Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2206the treatment of leaf functions.
a2c4f8e0 2207@end defmac
feca2ed3 2208
a2c4f8e0 2209@defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2210A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2211should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2212
2213If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
630d3d5a 2214function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
feca2ed3
JW
2215will cause the compiler to abort.
2216
2217Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2218treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2219this.
a2c4f8e0 2220@end defmac
feca2ed3 2221
54ff41b7
JW
2222@findex current_function_is_leaf
2223@findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
c237e94a
ZW
2224@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2225@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2226specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2227which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2228set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
08c148a8
NB
2229compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2230@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2231functions which only use leaf registers.
9ac617d4
EB
2232@code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2233that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2234@code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
feca2ed3
JW
2235@c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2236@c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2237
2238@node Stack Registers
2239@subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2240
2241There are special features to handle computers where some of the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2242``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2243pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2244stack.
feca2ed3 2245
a3a15b4d 2246Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
a2c4f8e0
ZW
2247they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2248support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2249point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2250stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2251@file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2252with it, as well as defining these macros.
2253
2254@defmac STACK_REGS
feca2ed3 2255Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
a2c4f8e0 2256@end defmac
feca2ed3 2257
1833192f
VM
2258@defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2259This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2260the machine has any stack-like registers.
2261@end defmac
2262
a2c4f8e0 2263@defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2264The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2265of the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2266@end defmac
feca2ed3 2267
a2c4f8e0 2268@defmac LAST_STACK_REG
feca2ed3
JW
2269The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2270the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2271@end defmac
feca2ed3 2272
feca2ed3
JW
2273@node Register Classes
2274@section Register Classes
2275@cindex register class definitions
2276@cindex class definitions, register
2277
2278On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2279For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2280certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2281restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2282
2283You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2284which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2285that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2286
2287@findex ALL_REGS
2288@findex NO_REGS
2289In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2290class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2291class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2292union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2293
2294@findex GENERAL_REGS
2295One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2296terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2297@samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2298the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2299to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2300
2301Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2302then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2303
2304The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2305constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2306You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2307them in operand constraints.
2308
6049a4c8
HPN
2309You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2310registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2311some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2312cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2313(@pxref{Costs}).
2314
feca2ed3
JW
2315You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2316instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2317either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2318certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
b899fd78
JR
2319which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2320or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
dd5a833e 2321class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
feca2ed3
JW
2322
2323You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2324classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2325contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2326in their union.
2327
2328When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2329certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2330Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2331a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2332specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2333
2334Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2335instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2336each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2337mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2338single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2339this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2340instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2341single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2342@code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2343
a2c4f8e0 2344@deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2eac577f
JM
2345An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2346as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2347must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
feca2ed3
JW
2348@code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2349tells how many classes there are.
2350
2351Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2352the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2353in many of the tables described below.
a2c4f8e0 2354@end deftp
feca2ed3 2355
a2c4f8e0 2356@defmac N_REG_CLASSES
feca2ed3
JW
2357The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2358
3ab51846 2359@smallexample
feca2ed3 2360#define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
3ab51846 2361@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 2362@end defmac
feca2ed3 2363
a2c4f8e0 2364@defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
2365An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2366constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
a2c4f8e0 2367@end defmac
feca2ed3 2368
a2c4f8e0 2369@defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
feca2ed3
JW
2370An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2371which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2372@var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2373register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2374
2375When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2376Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2377several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2378for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
7c272079
MP
2379In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2380registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2381so on.
a2c4f8e0 2382@end defmac
feca2ed3 2383
a2c4f8e0 2384@defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
2385A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2386@var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2387which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2388register.
a2c4f8e0 2389@end defmac
feca2ed3 2390
a2c4f8e0 2391@defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2392A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2393base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2394which is the register value plus a displacement.
a2c4f8e0 2395@end defmac
feca2ed3 2396
a2c4f8e0 2397@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
3dcc68a4 2398This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
c0478a66 2399the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
3dcc68a4
NC
2400@var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2401@code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
a2c4f8e0 2402@end defmac
3dcc68a4 2403
888d2cd6
DJ
2404@defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2405A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2406base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2407register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2408addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2409@end defmac
2410
86fc3d06 2411@defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
c4963a0a 2412A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
86fc3d06
UW
2413base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2414space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2415define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2416the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2417of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
c4963a0a
BS
2418@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2419index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2420@end defmac
2421
a2c4f8e0 2422@defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
feca2ed3
JW
2423A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2424index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2425address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2426added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
a2c4f8e0 2427@end defmac
feca2ed3 2428
a2c4f8e0 2429@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3 2430A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
1c62e8f2 2431suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
a2c4f8e0 2432@end defmac
feca2ed3 2433
a2c4f8e0 2434@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
861bb6c1
JL
2435A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2436that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2437@var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2438reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2439you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
ab873839
RW
2440@code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2441addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2442@code{address_operand}.
a2c4f8e0 2443@end defmac
861bb6c1 2444
888d2cd6
DJ
2445@defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2446A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2447use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2448memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2449pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2450define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2451than other base register uses.
c4963a0a
BS
2452
2453Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2454@code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2455@end defmac
2456
86fc3d06
UW
2457@defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2458A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2459suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2460memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2461This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
ab873839
RW
2462that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2463appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2464immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2465address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2466@code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2467corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
c4963a0a 2468@code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
ab873839 2469that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
888d2cd6
DJ
2470@end defmac
2471
a2c4f8e0 2472@defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
2473A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2474suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2475either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2476allocated such a hard register.
2477
2478The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2479the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2480two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2481labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2482labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2483may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2484looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2485only if neither labeling works.
a2c4f8e0 2486@end defmac
feca2ed3 2487
5f286f4a 2488@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
6d3fbe2f 2489A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
5f286f4a
YQ
2490@end deftypefn
2491
fba42e24
AS
2492@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2493A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2494to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2495@var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2496another, smaller class.
2497
2498The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2499
2500Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2501example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2502for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2503@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2504Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2505
2506One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2507@var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2508loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2509force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2510immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2511instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2512register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2513@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2514into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35 2515@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
fba42e24
AS
2516of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2517
2518If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2519through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2520to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2521reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2522this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2523the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2524@end deftypefn
2525
a2c4f8e0 2526@defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2527A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2528to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2529@var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2530another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2531safe:
2532
3ab51846 2533@smallexample
feca2ed3 2534#define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
3ab51846 2535@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
2536
2537Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2538example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2539for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2540@code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2541Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2542
222a2f1a
GK
2543One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2544@var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2545loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2546force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2547immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2548instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2549register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2550@var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2551into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
1a627b35
RS
2552@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2553of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
b5c82fa1
PB
2554
2555If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2556through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2557to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2558reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2559this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2560the SSE registers (and vice versa).
a2c4f8e0 2561@end defmac
feca2ed3 2562
abd26bfb
AS
2563@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2564Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2565input reloads.
2566
2567The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2568argument.
2569
2570You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2571reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2572@end deftypefn
2573
a2c4f8e0 2574@defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
feca2ed3
JW
2575A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2576to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2577@var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2578ordinarily be used.
2579
2580Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2581there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2582
2583The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2584smaller class.
2585
2586Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2587require the macro to do something nontrivial.
a2c4f8e0 2588@end defmac
feca2ed3 2589
ef4bddc2 2590@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
feca2ed3
JW
2591Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2592from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2593@samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
8a99f6f9
R
2594from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2595term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2596directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2597register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2598destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2599source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2600reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2601and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2602intermediate register still holds the required value.
2603
2604Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2605allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2606register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2607address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2608when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
e4ae5e77 2609as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
8a99f6f9
R
2610that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2611describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2612these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2613of the scratch register(s).
2614
2615In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2616
2617For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
9bdf23b2 2618and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
8a99f6f9 2619@var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
9bdf23b2 2620hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
8a99f6f9
R
2621needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2622
2623If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2624an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2625return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2626If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2627If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2628that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2629
2630If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2631perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2632closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2633required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2634copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2635
2636You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2637in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2638and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2639for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2640single-register-class
2641@c [later: or memory]
2642output constraint.
2643
2644When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2645hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2646register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2647have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2648
2649@c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2650@c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2651@c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2652@c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2653@c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2654@c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2655@c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2656@c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2657
2658
2659@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2660pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2661Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2662in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2663
2664Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2665currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2666to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2667
2668@code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2669copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2670(a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2671Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2672of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2673forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2674@end deftypefn
2675
2676@defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677@defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2678@defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
083cad55 2679These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
8a99f6f9
R
2680@code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2681
2682These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2683target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2684reload phase that it may
feca2ed3
JW
2685need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2686register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2687register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
8a99f6f9 2688you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
feca2ed3
JW
2689largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2690intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2691
2692If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2693intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
8a99f6f9
R
2694was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2695class required. If the
2696requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2697@code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
feca2ed3
JW
2698macros identically.
2699
2700The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2701Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2702can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2703@var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2704macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2705
2706If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
8a99f6f9 2707intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
feca2ed3 2708@samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
8a99f6f9 2709(@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
feca2ed3
JW
2710implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2711@samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2712register.
2713
8a99f6f9
R
2714These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2715register that
feca2ed3
JW
2716contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2717class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2718value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2719register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2720Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2721
2722@var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2723pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
630d3d5a 2724Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
feca2ed3
JW
2725in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2726
2727These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2728registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2729registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2730would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
a8154559 2731the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
feca2ed3
JW
2732intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2733general registers.
a2c4f8e0 2734@end defmac
feca2ed3 2735
a2c4f8e0 2736@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
feca2ed3
JW
2737Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2738to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
df2a54e9 2739those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
feca2ed3
JW
2740@var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2741class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2742and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2743
2744Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
a2c4f8e0 2745@end defmac
feca2ed3 2746
a2c4f8e0 2747@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2748Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2749allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2750If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2751defined by this macro.
2752
2753Do not define this macro if you do not define
2754@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
a2c4f8e0 2755@end defmac
feca2ed3 2756
a2c4f8e0 2757@defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2758When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2759registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2760hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2761load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2762same as that of @var{mode}.
2763
2764This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2765bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2766in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2767registers.
2768
2769However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2770the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2771differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2772widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2773suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2774details.
2775
2776Do not define this macro if you do not define
2777@code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2778is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
a2c4f8e0 2779@end defmac
feca2ed3 2780
07b8f0a8
AS
2781@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2782A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2783to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2784registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2785
2786The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2787has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
aeb9f7cf
SB
2788default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2789i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2790can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2791
2792This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2793transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2794pressure.
07b8f0a8
AS
2795@end deftypefn
2796
ef4bddc2 2797@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
a8c44c52
AS
2798A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2799of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2800
2801This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
1c7836f0 2802the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
a8c44c52
AS
2803@var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2804@code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2805values in the class @var{rclass}.
2806
2807This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2808in the reload pass.
2809
2810The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2811in words.
2812@end deftypefn
2813
a2c4f8e0 2814@defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
2815A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2816of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2817
2818This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2819the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2820should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2821@var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2822
2823This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2824in the reload pass.
a2c4f8e0 2825@end defmac
feca2ed3 2826
a2c4f8e0 2827@defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
b0c42aed
JH
2828If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2829a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
feca2ed3 2830
a271b387
RH
2831For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2832floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
feca2ed3 2833Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
57694e40 2834does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
cff9f8d5
AH
2835register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2836as below:
02188693 2837
3ab51846 2838@smallexample
b0c42aed
JH
2839#define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2840 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2841 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
3ab51846 2842@end smallexample
a271b387
RH
2843
2844Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2845if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2846than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2847mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2848or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2849eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2850Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2851entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2852value that the middle-end intended.
2853
a2c4f8e0 2854@end defmac
feca2ed3 2855
5074a1f8
VM
2856@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t})
2857A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2858 allocno class calculated by IRA.
2859
2860 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2861@end deftypefn
2862
55a2c322
VM
2863@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2864A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2865@end deftypefn
2866
2867@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2868A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2869@end deftypefn
2870
3b9ceb4b
VM
2871@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2872A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2873@end deftypefn
2874
55a2c322
VM
2875@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2876A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2877@end deftypefn
2878
d6220b11
KK
2879@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2880A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2881substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2882register allocation.
2883The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2884On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2885machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2886as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2887@end deftypefn
2888
14133a4d
KK
2889@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2890A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2891legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2892at memory mode @var{mode}.
2893The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2894This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2895addressing.
2896@end deftypefn
2897
ef4bddc2 2898@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
55a2c322
VM
2899This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2900@end deftypefn
2901
ef4bddc2 2902@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
42e37616
DM
2903This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2904@end deftypefn
2905
feca2ed3
JW
2906@node Stack and Calling
2907@section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2908@cindex calling conventions
2909
2910@c prevent bad page break with this line
2911This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2912
2913@menu
2914* Frame Layout::
7c16328b 2915* Exception Handling::
861bb6c1 2916* Stack Checking::
feca2ed3
JW
2917* Frame Registers::
2918* Elimination::
2919* Stack Arguments::
2920* Register Arguments::
2921* Scalar Return::
2922* Aggregate Return::
2923* Caller Saves::
2924* Function Entry::
2925* Profiling::
91d231cb 2926* Tail Calls::
7d69de61 2927* Stack Smashing Protection::
aaeaa9a9 2928* Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
feca2ed3
JW
2929@end menu
2930
2931@node Frame Layout
2932@subsection Basic Stack Layout
2933@cindex stack frame layout
2934@cindex frame layout
2935
2936@c prevent bad page break with this line
2937Here is the basic stack layout.
2938
a2c4f8e0 2939@defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
62f9f30b
TS
2940Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2941pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 2942@end defmac
feca2ed3 2943
a2c4f8e0 2944@defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
918a6124
GK
2945This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2946on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
04a5176a 2947@code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
918a6124
GK
2948
2949The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2950and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2951the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2952to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2953space for the next item on the stack.
2954
2955The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
62f9f30b 2956true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
918a6124 2957which is often wrong.
a2c4f8e0 2958@end defmac
918a6124 2959
a2c4f8e0 2960@defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
a4d05547 2961Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
f62c8a5c 2962are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
a2c4f8e0 2963@end defmac
feca2ed3 2964
a2c4f8e0 2965@defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
feca2ed3
JW
2966Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2967addresses on the stack.
a2c4f8e0 2968@end defmac
feca2ed3 2969
a2c4f8e0 2970@defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
2971Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2972
2973If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2974subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2975Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2976value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2977@c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2978@c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
a2c4f8e0 2979@end defmac
feca2ed3 2980
a2c4f8e0 2981@defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
95f3f59e 2982Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
0b4be7de 2983The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
95f3f59e 2984
0b4be7de 2985On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
95f3f59e
JDA
2986is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2987alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2988stack alignment and do it in the backend.
a2c4f8e0 2989@end defmac
95f3f59e 2990
a2c4f8e0 2991@defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
feca2ed3
JW
2992Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2993outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2994zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2995
2996If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2997the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
a2c4f8e0 2998@end defmac
feca2ed3 2999
a2c4f8e0 3000@defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3001Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3002address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3003function.
3004
3005If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3006the first argument's address.
a2c4f8e0 3007@end defmac
feca2ed3 3008
a2c4f8e0 3009@defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3010Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3011on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3012
3013The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3014length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3015machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
a2c4f8e0 3016@end defmac
feca2ed3 3017
c6d01079
AK
3018@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3019A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
083cad55 3020stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
c8f27794
JW
3021@code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3022default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
083cad55 3023elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
c8f27794 3024@code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
c6d01079
AK
3025@end defmac
3026
a2c4f8e0 3027@defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3
JW
3028A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3029frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3030@var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3031itself.
3032
3033If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3034of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3035address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
a2c4f8e0 3036@end defmac
feca2ed3 3037
a2c4f8e0 3038@defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
baf37960 3039A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
feca2ed3 3040setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
981f6289 3041on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
0bc02db4 3042before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
baf37960 3043define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
a2c4f8e0 3044@end defmac
0bc02db4 3045
9ddb66ef 3046@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
d6da68b9 3047This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
0bc02db4
MS
3048the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3049The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
d6da68b9 3050machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
0bc02db4 3051@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
d6da68b9 3052@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3053
224869d9
EB
3054@defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3055A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3056address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3057of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3058You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3059as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3060@end defmac
3061
a2c4f8e0 3062@defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
feca2ed3 3063A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
861bb6c1
JL
3064address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3065the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3066frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
a55bbe13 3067@code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
feca2ed3 3068
e9a25f70 3069The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
4830ba1f 3070@var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
e9a25f70 3071determine the return address of other frames.
a2c4f8e0 3072@end defmac
e9a25f70 3073
a2c4f8e0 3074@defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
a55bbe13
L
3075Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3076stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3077frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
a2c4f8e0 3078@end defmac
861bb6c1 3079
a2c4f8e0 3080@defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
861bb6c1
JL
3081A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3082incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3083prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3084value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3085the stack.
3086
3087You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3088debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3089
2c849145 3090If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
aee96fe9 3091@code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
a2c4f8e0 3092@end defmac
2c849145 3093
ed80cd68 3094@defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
73774972 3095A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
5cd0f915
RS
3096number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3097must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3098be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3099
3100This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3101general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3102frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3103over time.
ed80cd68
RH
3104@end defmac
3105
282efe1c
RH
3106@defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3107A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3108number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3109only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3110someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3111terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3112@end defmac
3113
e54c7471
EB
3114@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3115This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3116contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3117info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3118@smallexample
923158be 3119(set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
e54c7471
EB
3120@end smallexample
3121and
3122@smallexample
923158be 3123(set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
e54c7471
EB
3124@end smallexample
3125to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3126the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3127the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3128@end deftypefn
3129
a2c4f8e0 3130@defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
861bb6c1
JL
3131A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3132from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3133frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3134the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3135previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3136
71038426
RH
3137You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3138debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3139@end defmac
71038426 3140
a2c4f8e0 3141@defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
71038426
RH
3142A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3143from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
02f52e19 3144final value should coincide with that calculated by
71038426
RH
3145@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3146during virtual register instantiation.
3147
d17c29c3
PB
3148The default value for this macro is
3149@code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
2c849145 3150which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
208e52d9
JM
3151immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3152some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3153and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
2c849145 3154
208e52d9 3155You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
2c849145
JM
3156want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3157DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3158@end defmac
512b62fb 3159
f6672e8e
RH
3160@defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3161If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3162in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
6fc0bb99 3163The final value should coincide with that calculated by
f6672e8e
RH
3164@code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3165
3166Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
083cad55 3167via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
f6672e8e 3168variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
6416ae7f 3169defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
f6672e8e
RH
3170based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3171of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3172should be defined.
3173@end defmac
3174
35d177a2
AO
3175@defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3176If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3177in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3178in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3179may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3180@end defmac
3181
7c16328b
RH
3182@node Exception Handling
3183@subsection Exception Handling Support
3184@cindex exception handling
3185
a2c4f8e0 3186@defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
52a11cbf
RH
3187A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3188data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3189@var{N} registers are usable.
3190
3191The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3192handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3193should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3194but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
31952 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3196
3197You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3198handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3199@end defmac
52a11cbf 3200
a2c4f8e0 3201@defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
52a11cbf
RH
3202A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3203to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3204This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3205It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3206
02f52e19 3207Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
52a11cbf
RH
3208untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3209
34dc173c 3210Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
73774972
EC
3211by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3212this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3213stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3214this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
34dc173c 3215that provided by DWARF 2.
a2c4f8e0 3216@end defmac
52a11cbf 3217
a2c4f8e0 3218@defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
52a11cbf 3219A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
02f52e19 3220to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
52a11cbf
RH
3221return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3222
3223Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
02f52e19
AJ
3224return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3225address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
52a11cbf 3226the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
73774972
EC
3227frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3228been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
34dc173c 3229target call frame.
52a11cbf
RH
3230
3231Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3232address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3233the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3234
3235If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3236define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
a2c4f8e0 3237@end defmac
52a11cbf 3238
1e60c057
R
3239@defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3240If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3241to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3242exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3243using it to return to the exception handler.
3244@end defmac
3245
a2c4f8e0 3246@defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
2a1ee410
RH
3247This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3248handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3249that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3250and so may be read-only.
3251
aee96fe9
JM
3252@var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3253@var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
2a1ee410
RH
3254The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3255as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3256
ebb48a4d 3257If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
2a1ee410 3258represented directly.
a2c4f8e0 3259@end defmac
2a1ee410 3260
a2c4f8e0 3261@defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
2a1ee410
RH
3262This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3263to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3264Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3265be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3266
aee96fe9
JM
3267This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3268handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3269of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
2a1ee410 3270to be emitted.
a2c4f8e0 3271@end defmac
2a1ee410 3272
8662eb14 3273@defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
44082375 3274This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
7c16328b
RH
3275code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3276available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3277through signal frames.
3278
614e5a7d
BE
3279This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3280@file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3281@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
7c16328b
RH
3282@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3283for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
614e5a7d
BE
3284the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3285save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3286evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3287the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
8207b189
FS
3288
3289For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3290@code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
a2c4f8e0 3291@end defmac
861bb6c1 3292
3950dcdf
JJ
3293@defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3294This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3295call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3296usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3297
0c93ed52
SB
3298This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3299@file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3950dcdf
JJ
3300@var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3301for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3302@code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3303be updated in @var{fs}.
3304@end defmac
3305
4746cf84
MA
3306@defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3307A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3308info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3309linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3310@end defmac
3311
861bb6c1
JL
3312@node Stack Checking
3313@subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3314
b38f3813
EB
3315GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3316stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3317three ways:
861bb6c1
JL
3318
3319@enumerate
3320@item
a3a15b4d 3321If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
b38f3813
EB
3322will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3323at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3324other special processing.
861bb6c1
JL
3325
3326@item
b38f3813
EB
3327If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3328@code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3329that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3330static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3331in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3332stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3333approach below.
861bb6c1
JL
3334
3335@item
a3a15b4d 3336If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
861bb6c1
JL
3337``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3338@end enumerate
3339
b38f3813
EB
3340If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3341GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3342@option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3343dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
861bb6c1 3344
a2c4f8e0 3345@defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
861bb6c1 3346A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
02f52e19 3347machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
65a324b4 3348is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
b38f3813
EB
3349checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3350value of this macro is zero.
3351@end defmac
3352
3353@defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3354A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3355in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3356like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3357approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
a2c4f8e0 3358@end defmac
861bb6c1 3359
d809253a
EB
3360@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3361An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3362instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3363define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3364the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3365of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 3366@end defmac
861bb6c1 3367
d809253a
EB
3368@defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3369An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3370when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3371contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3372thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3373is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3374default value of this macro is zero.
3375@end defmac
3376
a2c4f8e0 3377@defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
507d0069 3378The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
c55721c0 3379languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
507d0069 3380with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
c55721c0
EB
33818KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3382architectures and operating systems.
a2c4f8e0 3383@end defmac
861bb6c1 3384
b38f3813
EB
3385The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3386nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3387in the opposite case.
3388
a2c4f8e0 3389@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3390The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
861bb6c1
JL
3391instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3392stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
a3a15b4d
JL
3393checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3394default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
861bb6c1 3395systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 3396@end defmac
861bb6c1 3397
a2c4f8e0 3398@defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3399GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
861bb6c1
JL
3400represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3401space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3402You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3403use the default of four words.
a2c4f8e0 3404@end defmac
861bb6c1 3405
a2c4f8e0 3406@defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
a3a15b4d 3407The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
861bb6c1 3408fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
630d3d5a 3409@option{-fstack-check}.
a3a15b4d 3410GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
861bb6c1 3411normally not need to override that default.
a2c4f8e0 3412@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3413
3414@need 2000
3415@node Frame Registers
3416@subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3417
3418@c prevent bad page break with this line
3419This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3420
a2c4f8e0 3421@defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3422The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3423fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3424the hardware determines which register this is.
a2c4f8e0 3425@end defmac
feca2ed3 3426
a2c4f8e0 3427@defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3428The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3429access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3430hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3431choose any register you wish for this purpose.
a2c4f8e0 3432@end defmac
feca2ed3 3433
a2c4f8e0 3434@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3435On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3436offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3437allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3438between these two locations). On those machines, define
3439@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3440be used internally until the offset is known, and define
556e0f21 3441@code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
feca2ed3
JW
3442used for the frame pointer.
3443
3444You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3445is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3446the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3447completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3448definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3449@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3450or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3451
3452Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3453@code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
a2c4f8e0 3454@end defmac
feca2ed3 3455
a2c4f8e0 3456@defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3457The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3458the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3459frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3460register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3461wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3462pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3463@code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3464(@pxref{Elimination}).
a2c4f8e0 3465@end defmac
feca2ed3 3466
e3339d0f
JM
3467@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3468Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3469@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3470the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3471== FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3472definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3473@end defmac
3474
3475@defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3476Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3477@code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3478same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3479ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3480definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3481@end defmac
3482
a2c4f8e0 3483@defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3484The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3485access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3486machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3487pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3488to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3489@code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3490
3491Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3492address from the stack.
a2c4f8e0 3493@end defmac
feca2ed3 3494
a2c4f8e0
ZW
3495@defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3496@defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
3497Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3498register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3499function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3500number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3501these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
bd819a4a 3502not be defined.
feca2ed3
JW
3503
3504The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3505
3506If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
2b4fa409 3507defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
a2c4f8e0 3508@end defmac
919543ab 3509
c21df29b 3510@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
531ca746
RH
3511This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3512targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3513nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3514attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3515those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3516
3517The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
2b4fa409
RH
3518
3519If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3520provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3521Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3522from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3523will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3524@findex stack_pointer_rtx
3525@findex frame_pointer_rtx
3526@findex arg_pointer_rtx
3527The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3528@code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3529to refer to those items.
531ca746
RH
3530@end deftypefn
3531
a2c4f8e0 3532@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3533This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3534saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3535DWARF2 exception handling.
3536
3537Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3538exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3539extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3540in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3541used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3542routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3543registers that are not call-saved.
3544
3545If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3546@code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
a2c4f8e0 3547@end defmac
919543ab 3548
a2c4f8e0 3549@defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
919543ab
AH
3550
3551This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3552for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3553
3554If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3555@code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
a2c4f8e0 3556@end defmac
919543ab 3557
a2c4f8e0 3558@defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
41f3a930
AH
3559
3560Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3561is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
61aeb06f 3562Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
41f3a930
AH
3563column number to use instead.
3564
73774972 3565See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
a2c4f8e0 3566@end defmac
feca2ed3 3567
34c80057
AM
3568@defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3569
3570Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3571used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
2dd76960 3572debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
34c80057
AM
3573should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3574@code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3575
3576@end defmac
3577
3578@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3579
3580Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
2dd76960 3581that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
34c80057 3582should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
f676971a 3583.eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
34c80057
AM
3584return @code{@var{regno}}.
3585
3586@end defmac
3587
cca2207a
L
3588@defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3589
3590Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3591@code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3592target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3593default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3594
3595@end defmac
3596
3597@defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3598
3599Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3600context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3601it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3602defined and 0 otherwise.
3603
3604@end defmac
3605
feca2ed3
JW
3606@node Elimination
3607@subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3608
3609@c prevent bad page break with this line
3610This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3611
b52b1749
AS
3612@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3613This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3614a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3615value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
feca2ed3 3616
b52b1749 3617This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
aea88c05
AS
3618according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3619constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3620to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3621Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3622pointer.
feca2ed3
JW
3623
3624In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3625without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3626automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
b52b1749 3627@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
bd819a4a 3628them.
feca2ed3
JW
3629
3630In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3631register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3632fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
aea88c05 3633
b52b1749
AS
3634Default return value is @code{false}.
3635@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3636
feca2ed3 3637@findex get_frame_size
a2c4f8e0 3638@defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3639A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3640between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3641the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3642such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3643registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3644
3645If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3646need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
65a324b4 3647@code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
feca2ed3 3648case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
a2c4f8e0 3649@end defmac
feca2ed3 3650
a2c4f8e0 3651@defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
feca2ed3
JW
3652If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3653eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3654defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3655references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3656
3657The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3658of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3659
3660On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3661the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3662must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3663replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3664depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3665
3666In this case, you might specify:
3ab51846 3667@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3668#define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3669@{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3670 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3671 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3ab51846 3672@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3673
3674Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3675specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
a2c4f8e0 3676@end defmac
feca2ed3 3677
9ddb66ef 3678@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
7b5cbb57 3679This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
9ddb66ef
JR
3680try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3681@var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3be639f7 3682is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
feca2ed3
JW
3683preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3684knows about.
3be639f7 3685
7b5cbb57
AS
3686Default return value is @code{true}.
3687@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3688
a2c4f8e0 3689@defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
feca2ed3
JW
3690This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3691specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3692registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3693defined.
a2c4f8e0 3694@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3695
3696@node Stack Arguments
3697@subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3698@cindex arguments on stack
3699@cindex stack arguments
3700
3701The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3702on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3703control passing certain arguments in registers.
3704
9ddb66ef 3705@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
3706This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3707prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3708passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3709cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3710The default is to not promote prototypes.
3711@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3712
a2c4f8e0 3713@defmac PUSH_ARGS
767094dd 3714A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
f73ad30e
JH
3715outgoing arguments.
3716If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3717That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3718allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
aee96fe9 3719it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
a2c4f8e0 3720@end defmac
f73ad30e 3721
9d6bef95
JM
3722@defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3723A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3724last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3725defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3726and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3727@end defmac
3728
a2c4f8e0 3729@defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
feca2ed3
JW
3730A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3731stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
feca2ed3
JW
3732
3733On some machines, the definition
3734
3ab51846 3735@smallexample
feca2ed3 3736#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3ab51846 3737@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
3738
3739@noindent
3740will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3741to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3742alignment. Then the definition should be
3743
3ab51846 3744@smallexample
feca2ed3 3745#define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3ab51846 3746@end smallexample
4a6336ad 3747
64ad7c99 3748If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
a2c4f8e0 3749@end defmac
feca2ed3 3750
29454ff5
SL
3751@findex outgoing_args_size
3752@findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
a2c4f8e0 3753@defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
767094dd 3754A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
29454ff5
SL
3755will be computed and placed into
3756@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
feca2ed3
JW
3757onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3758increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3759
f73ad30e 3760Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
feca2ed3 3761is not proper.
a2c4f8e0 3762@end defmac
feca2ed3 3763
a2c4f8e0 3764@defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
feca2ed3
JW
3765Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3766allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3767registers.
3768
3769The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
ab87f8c8 3770arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
a3a15b4d 3771which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
5d059ed9
KT
3772The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3773of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3774
3775This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3776machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3777which.
a2c4f8e0 3778@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3779@c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3780@c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3781
ddbb449f
AM
3782@defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3783Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3784Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3785is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3786can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3787@end defmac
3788
81464b2c
KT
3789@defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3790Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3791caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3792when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3793if the function called is a library function.
feca2ed3
JW
3794
3795If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3796whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
29454ff5 3797@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
a2c4f8e0 3798@end defmac
feca2ed3 3799
a2c4f8e0 3800@defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
feca2ed3
JW
3801Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3802stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3803@c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3804@c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3805
3806Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3807stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3808suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3809stack in its natural location.
a2c4f8e0 3810@end defmac
feca2ed3 3811
893d13d5 3812@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
079e7538
NF
3813This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3814a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3815and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
feca2ed3
JW
3816
3817@var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3818the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3819@code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
91d231cb 3820From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
feca2ed3
JW
3821
3822@var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3823describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3824@code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3825From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3826arguments (if known).
3827
861bb6c1 3828When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
feca2ed3
JW
3829will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3830you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3831by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3832a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3833in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3834
893d13d5 3835@var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
feca2ed3
JW
3836stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3837argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3838
8aeea6e6 3839On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
893d13d5 3840of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
feca2ed3
JW
3841calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3842the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3843convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3844arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3845nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3846@var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3847number of arguments.
079e7538 3848@end deftypefn
fa5322fa 3849
a2c4f8e0 3850@defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
fa5322fa
AO
3851A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3852pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3853when compiling a function call.
3854
3855@var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3856have been accumulated.
3857
3858On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3859that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3860that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3861call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3862appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 3863@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
3864
3865@node Register Arguments
3866@subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3867@cindex arguments in registers
3868@cindex registers arguments
3869
3870This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3871types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3872the stack.
3873
ef4bddc2 3874@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
3875Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3876register and if so, which register.
feca2ed3 3877
b25b9e8f 3878The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
feca2ed3
JW
3879arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3880the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3881(which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
b25b9e8f
NF
3882which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3883nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3884function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3885syntax error has previously occurred.
feca2ed3 3886
b25b9e8f
NF
3887The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3888register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3889on the stack.
feca2ed3 3890
d5e254e1
IE
3891The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3892passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3893should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3894@code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3895for more information.
3896
161d7b59 3897The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
feca2ed3 3898used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
ce376beb 3899@code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
feca2ed3 3900@code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
f797c10b
NC
3901describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3902@code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3903register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3904register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3905second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3906the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
02f52e19 3907As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
c980b85b
NC
3908RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3909argument is also stored on the stack.
feca2ed3 3910
b25b9e8f 3911The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
1cc5e432
GK
3912VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3913pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3914
feca2ed3 3915@cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
b25b9e8f
NF
3916The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3917machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3918cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3919done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3920@var{named} is @code{false}.
3921
3922@cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3923@cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
fe984136 3924You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
feca2ed3
JW
3925in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3926type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
b25b9e8f 3927is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
feca2ed3
JW
3928argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3929defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3930a register.
b25b9e8f 3931@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3932
ef4bddc2 3933@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
fe984136
RH
3934This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3935solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
d9a4ee00
JL
3936definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3937documentation.
fe984136 3938@end deftypefn
d9a4ee00 3939
ef4bddc2 3940@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f 3941Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
feca2ed3
JW
3942that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3943necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3944argument.
3945
b25b9e8f
NF
3946For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3947which the caller passes the value, and
3948@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3949fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3950arrive.
feca2ed3 3951
b25b9e8f
NF
3952If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3953@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3954@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3955
bcb21886
KY
3956@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3957This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3958for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3959@end deftypefn
3960
3961@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3962Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3963This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3964@end deftypefn
3965
ef4bddc2 3966@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
78a52f11
RH
3967This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3968argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
feca2ed3
JW
3969arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3970pushed on the stack.
3971
3972On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3973registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
78a52f11 3974first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
feca2ed3
JW
3975on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3976structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3977in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
78a52f11 3978compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
feca2ed3 3979
b25b9e8f 3980@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
feca2ed3 3981register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
b25b9e8f 3982@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
78a52f11 3983@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3984
ef4bddc2 3985@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
f676971a 3986This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
8cd5a4e0 3987position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
f676971a 3988predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
8cd5a4e0
RH
3989passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3990
3991If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
feca2ed3
JW
3992pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3993The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3994to that type.
8cd5a4e0 3995@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 3996
ef4bddc2 3997@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
6cdd5672
RH
3998The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3999known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4000function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4001by the caller.
4002
a1c496cb 4003For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
6cdd5672
RH
4004determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4005not be generated.
4006
4007The default version of this hook always returns false.
4008@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4009
a2c4f8e0 4010@defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
b25b9e8f
NF
4011A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4012of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4013target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4014of bytes of argument so far.
feca2ed3
JW
4015
4016There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4017arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4018variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4019arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4020@code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4021should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 4022@end defmac
feca2ed3 4023
7c800926
KT
4024@defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4025If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4026function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4027created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4028reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4029If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4030@var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4031@end defmac
4032
0f6937fe 4033@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
a2c4f8e0
ZW
4034A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4035@var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4036variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4037is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4038the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4039For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4040declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4041@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
0f6937fe
AM
4042being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4043arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4044parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
78466c0e 4045@var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
feca2ed3
JW
4046
4047When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4048@var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4049contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4050an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4051macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4052never both of them at once.
a2c4f8e0 4053@end defmac
feca2ed3 4054
a2c4f8e0 4055@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
97fc4caf
AO
4056Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4057it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4058@code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4059is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
40600)} is used instead.
a2c4f8e0 4061@end defmac
97fc4caf 4062
a2c4f8e0 4063@defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
feca2ed3
JW
4064Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4065finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4066undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4067
4068The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
161d7b59 4069with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
feca2ed3
JW
4070argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4071@code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4072@c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4073@c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4074@end defmac
feca2ed3 4075
ef4bddc2 4076@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
b25b9e8f
NF
4077This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4078advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4079@var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4080the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4081argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
feca2ed3 4082
b25b9e8f 4083This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
feca2ed3
JW
4084on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4085used for arguments without any special help.
b25b9e8f 4086@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4087
099590dc
MM
4088@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4089If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4090offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4091which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4092slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4093top.
4094@end defmac
4095
a2c4f8e0 4096@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
feca2ed3
JW
4097If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4098to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4099@code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4100@code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4101
123148b5
BS
4102The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4103target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4104always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
feca2ed3
JW
4105
4106This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4107For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4108big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4109constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
a2c4f8e0 4110@end defmac
feca2ed3 4111
a2c4f8e0 4112@defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
02f52e19
AJ
4113If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4114implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
5e4f6244
CP
4115next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4116controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4117arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
a2c4f8e0 4118@end defmac
5e4f6244 4119
6e985040
AM
4120@defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4121Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4122memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4123macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4124machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4125@code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4126registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4127a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4128required.
4129@end defmac
4130
ef4bddc2 4131@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
2b0d3573 4132This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
c2ed6cf8
NF
4133with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4134@code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4135@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4136
ef4bddc2 4137@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
123148b5
BS
4138Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4139which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4140return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4141value.
4142@end deftypefn
4143
a2c4f8e0 4144@defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4145A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4146register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4147@emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4148the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4149used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4150stack.
a2c4f8e0 4151@end defmac
bb1b857a 4152
9ddb66ef 4153@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
42ba5130
RH
4154This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4155as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4156arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4157to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4158AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4159registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4160point register.
4161
4162The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4163false.
4164@end deftypefn
ded9bf77 4165
d3da4d14
RH
4166@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4167This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4168The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4169@end deftypefn
4170
07a5b2bc 4171@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
d4048208
KT
4172This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4173to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4174variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
07a5b2bc 4175to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
d4048208 4176variable.
07a5b2bc 4177The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
d4048208
KT
4178this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4179internal type.
4180If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4181Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4182macro to iterate through all types.
4183@end deftypefn
4184
35cbb299
KT
4185@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4186This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4187@var{fndecl}.
4188The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4189@end deftypefn
4190
4191@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4192This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4193type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4194@code{NULL_TREE}.
4195@end deftypefn
4196
9ddb66ef 4197@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
23a60a04
JM
4198This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4199@code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4200arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4201@code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
23a60a04
JM
4202@end deftypefn
4203
ef4bddc2 4204@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
e09ec166
EC
4205Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4206with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4207hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4208@end deftypefn
4209
84562394 4210@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
7352c013
RG
4211Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4212@end deftypefn
4213
ef4bddc2 4214@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
6dd53648
RH
4215Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4216insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4217considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4218must work.
4219
4220The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4221required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4222Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4223code in @file{optabs.c}.
4224@end deftypefn
4225
ef4bddc2 4226@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
f676971a
EC
4227Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4228insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4229must have move patterns for this mode.
4230@end deftypefn
4231
ef4bddc2 4232@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
0f6d54f7
RS
4233Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4234of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4235Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4236and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4237
4238One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4239that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4240has operations like:
4241
4242@smallexample
4243int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4244@end smallexample
4245
4246where the return type is defined as:
4247
4248@smallexample
4249typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4250@{
4251 int8x8_t val[3];
4252@} int8x8x3_t;
4253@end smallexample
4254
4255If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4256@code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4257@code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4258@end deftypefn
4259
ef4bddc2 4260@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
8cc4b7a2
JM
4261Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4262floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4263@code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4264hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4265@code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4266@end deftypefn
4267
ef4bddc2 4268@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
42db504c
SB
4269Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4270small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4271@var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4272in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4273In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4274for any mode.
4275
4276On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4277insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4278to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4279if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4280insn.
4281
4282Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4283in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4284the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4285classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4286registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4287registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4288SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4289strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4290machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4291
2b0d3573 4292The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
42db504c
SB
4293safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4294unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4295that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4296to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4297of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4298@end deftypefn
4299
feca2ed3
JW
4300@node Scalar Return
4301@subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4302@cindex return values in registers
4303@cindex values, returned by functions
4304@cindex scalars, returned as values
4305
4306This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4307values---values that can fit in registers.
4308
9ddb66ef 4309@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
1b03c58a
RG
4310
4311Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4312returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
e4ae5e77 4313representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
1b03c58a
RG
4314representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4315function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4316compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4317Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4318a function returns a value.
4319
4320On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4321(Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4322place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4323@code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4324The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
b25b9e8f 4325multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
576c9028
KH
4326@code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4327location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4328the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4329that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4330port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4331@samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
1b03c58a
RG
4332
4333If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4334the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4335@var{valtype} is a scalar type.
feca2ed3
JW
4336
4337If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4338node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4339pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4340convention for specific functions when all their calls are
bd819a4a 4341known.
feca2ed3 4342
1b03c58a
RG
4343Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4344which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4345the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4346different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4347
4348@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4349aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
cea28603 4350@code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
1b03c58a
RG
4351@end deftypefn
4352
4353@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4354This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4355a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4356@end defmac
feca2ed3 4357
a2c4f8e0 4358@defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3 4359A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
dc672951 4360function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3
JW
4361
4362Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4363support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4364specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4365compiled.
a2c4f8e0 4366@end defmac
feca2ed3 4367
ef4bddc2 4368@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
390b17c2 4369Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
ff2ce160 4370function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
390b17c2
RE
4371
4372The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
ff2ce160 4373library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
390b17c2
RE
4374representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4375
4376If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4377@end deftypefn
4378
a2c4f8e0 4379@defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
4380A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4381register in which the values of called function may come back.
4382
4383A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4384second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4385recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4386suffices:
4387
3ab51846 4388@smallexample
feca2ed3 4389#define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
3ab51846 4390@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
4391
4392If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4393function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4394should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
82f81f18
AS
4395
4396This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4397for a new target instead.
a2c4f8e0 4398@end defmac
feca2ed3 4399
82f81f18
AS
4400@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4401A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4402register in which the values of called function may come back.
4403
4404A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4405second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4406recognized by this target hook.
4407
4408If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4409function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4410should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4411
4412If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4413@end deftypefn
4414
a2c4f8e0 4415@defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
feca2ed3
JW
4416Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4417need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4418saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
a2c4f8e0 4419@end defmac
feca2ed3 4420
e0d14c39
BS
4421@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4422Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4423is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4424arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4425pointer return value. Define this to true if that behaviour is
4426undesirable on your target.
4427@end deftypevr
4428
9ddb66ef 4429@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
c988af2b
RS
4430This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4431at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4432padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4433is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4434
1b03c58a
RG
4435Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4436be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4437or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
44384-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4439@code{SImode} rtx.
c988af2b
RS
4440@end deftypefn
4441
feca2ed3
JW
4442@node Aggregate Return
4443@subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4444@cindex aggregates as return values
4445@cindex large return values
4446@cindex returning aggregate values
4447@cindex structure value address
4448
4449When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
1b03c58a
RG
4450cases), the value is not returned according to
4451@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4452caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4453should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4454address}.
feca2ed3
JW
4455
4456This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4457memory.
4458
9ddb66ef 4459@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
61f71b34
DD
4460This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4461function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4462Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4463will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4464libcalls.
feca2ed3
JW
4465
4466Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
61f71b34 4467by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
feca2ed3 4468takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
61f71b34 4469possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
feca2ed3
JW
4470definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4471values, and 0 otherwise.
4472
61f71b34 4473Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
feca2ed3
JW
4474be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4475to indicate this.
61f71b34 4476@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4477
a2c4f8e0 4478@defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4479Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4480in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
161d7b59 4481only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
feca2ed3 4482If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
d624465f
KH
4483and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4484target hook.
feca2ed3
JW
4485
4486If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
a2c4f8e0 4487@end defmac
feca2ed3 4488
61f71b34
DD
4489@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4490This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4491address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4492passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
1f6acb82
KH
4493be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4494hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4495argument.
feca2ed3 4496
feca2ed3
JW
4497On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4498is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4499caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4500be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
2225b57c
CD
4501@var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4502the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
61f71b34 4503the caller.
feca2ed3 4504
917f1b7e 4505If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
2225b57c
CD
4506stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4507@var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
64ee9490 4508structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
2225b57c 4509to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
61f71b34 4510@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4511
a2c4f8e0 4512@defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
feca2ed3
JW
4513Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4514for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4515the address of a static variable containing the value.
4516
4517Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4518pass an address to the subroutine.
4519
630d3d5a
JM
4520This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4521nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
a2c4f8e0 4522@end defmac
feca2ed3 4523
ef4bddc2 4524@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
ffa88471
SE
4525This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4526@end deftypefn
4527
ef4bddc2 4528@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
ffa88471
SE
4529This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4530@end deftypefn
4531
feca2ed3
JW
4532@node Caller Saves
4533@subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4534
a3a15b4d 4535If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
feca2ed3
JW
4536makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4537must live across calls.
4538
a2c4f8e0 4539@defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
8d5c8167
JL
4540A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4541of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4542@var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4543returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4544will select the smallest suitable mode.
a2c4f8e0 4545@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4546
4547@node Function Entry
4548@subsection Function Entry and Exit
4549@cindex function entry and exit
4550@cindex prologue
4551@cindex epilogue
4552
4553This section describes the macros that output function entry
4554(@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4555
08c148a8
NB
4556@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4557If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
feca2ed3
JW
4558function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4559initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4560saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4561local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4562stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4563
4564The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4565macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4566
4567@findex regs_ever_live
4568To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4569@code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4570@var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4571prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
08c148a8 4572call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
feca2ed3
JW
4573@code{regs_ever_live}.)
4574
4575On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4576not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4577they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4578appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4579registers are used in the function.
4580
4581@findex frame_pointer_needed
4582On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4583function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4584pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4585frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4586@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4587time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4588
4589The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4590required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4591listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4592order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4593stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4594the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4595for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4596compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4597or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4598need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
08c148a8
NB
4599@end deftypefn
4600
17b53c33
NB
4601@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4602If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4603prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4604emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4605emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4606@end deftypefn
4607
4608@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4609If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4610epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4611emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4612emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4613@end deftypefn
4614
08c148a8
NB
4615@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4616If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4617function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4618registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4619called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4620same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4621registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4622@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4623
4624On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4625of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4626instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4627@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4628
4629Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4630@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4631switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4632define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4633target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4634condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4635
4636On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4637function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4638two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4639is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4640@code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4641a function that needs a frame pointer.
4642
4643Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4644@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4645The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4646function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4647
4648On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4649others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4650given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4651number of arguments.
4652
29454ff5
SL
4653@findex pops_args
4654@findex crtl->args.pops_args
08c148a8
NB
4655Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4656functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
72392b81
JR
4657needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4658function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4659@code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
08c148a8
NB
4660@end deftypefn
4661
feca2ed3
JW
4662@itemize @bullet
4663@item
29454ff5
SL
4664@findex pretend_args_size
4665@findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4666A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
feca2ed3
JW
4667uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4668stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4669if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4670arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4671yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4672region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4673registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
6c535c69 4674features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
feca2ed3
JW
4675
4676@item
4677An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4678The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4679the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4680machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4681in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4682a save area.
4683
4684@item
4685A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4686boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4687this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4688save area closer to the top of the stack.
4689
4690@item
4691@cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4692Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
29454ff5 4693@code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
feca2ed3
JW
4694argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4695@end itemize
4696
a2c4f8e0 4697@defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
feca2ed3
JW
4698Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4699instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4700pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
9d05bbce
KH
4701adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4702default is 0.
feca2ed3
JW
4703
4704Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4705frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4706stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4707compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
a2c4f8e0 4708@end defmac
feca2ed3 4709
a2c4f8e0 4710@defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
8760eaae 4711Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
feca2ed3 4712used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
86c33cd0 4713pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
a2c4f8e0 4714@end defmac
feca2ed3 4715
a2c4f8e0 4716@defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
15b5aef3
RH
4717Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4718used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4719on entry to an exception edge.
a2c4f8e0 4720@end defmac
15b5aef3 4721
65e71cd6 4722@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
483ab821 4723A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
feca2ed3
JW
4724function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4725inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4726adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4727the real function.
4728
4729First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4730contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4731contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4732in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
e979f9e8 4733e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
feca2ed3
JW
4734all other incoming arguments.
4735
65e71cd6
EB
4736Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4737made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4738adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4739
4740@smallexample
4741p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4742@end smallexample
4743
4744After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
feca2ed3
JW
4745@code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4746not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4747return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4748
4749The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4750the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
08c148a8
NB
4751of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4752and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
feca2ed3
JW
4753
4754The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4755have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4756some targets, but probably not.
4757
861bb6c1 4758If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
c771326b 4759front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
861bb6c1
JL
4760@var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4761not support varargs.
483ab821
MM
4762@end deftypefn
4763
9ddb66ef 4764@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
65e71cd6
EB
4765A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4766to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4767arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4768generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4769previously exposed.
483ab821 4770@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
4771
4772@node Profiling
4773@subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4774@cindex profiling, code generation
4775
4776These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4777
a2c4f8e0 4778@defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
feca2ed3
JW
4779A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4780assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
feca2ed3
JW
4781
4782@findex mcount
980e2067 4783The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
161d7b59 4784your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
980e2067
JL
4785compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4786compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4787
4788Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4789variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4790@samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4791the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
a2c4f8e0 4792@end defmac
980e2067 4793
a2c4f8e0 4794@defmac PROFILE_HOOK
411707f4
CC
4795A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4796code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4797not support profiling.
a2c4f8e0 4798@end defmac
411707f4 4799
a2c4f8e0 4800@defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
8b65a354
JZ
4801Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4802@code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4803allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4804implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4805@var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
a2c4f8e0 4806@end defmac
feca2ed3 4807
a2c4f8e0 4808@defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
feca2ed3
JW
4809Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4810the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
a2c4f8e0 4811@end defmac
feca2ed3 4812
d56a43a0
AK
4813@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4814This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4815@end deftypefn
4816
91d231cb
JM
4817@node Tail Calls
4818@subsection Permitting tail calls
4819@cindex tail calls
b36f4ed3 4820
4977bab6 4821@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
5bd40ade 4822True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4977bab6
ZW
4823call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4824or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4cb1433c
RH
4825
4826It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4827tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4977bab6 4828during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
02f52e19 4829as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4977bab6
ZW
4830``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4831may vary greatly between different architectures.
4832@end deftypefn
4cb1433c 4833
9ddb66ef 4834@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
912f2dac
DB
4835Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4836function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4837cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4838registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4839TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4840FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4841@end deftypefn
4842
ee3d2ecd
JJ
4843@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4844This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4845@end deftypefn
4846
d45eae79
SL
4847@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4848True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4849@end deftypefn
4850
7d69de61
RH
4851@node Stack Smashing Protection
4852@subsection Stack smashing protection
4853@cindex stack smashing protection
4854
4855@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4856This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
083cad55 4857for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
7d69de61
RH
4858runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4859that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4860variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4861
4862The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4863@samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4864@end deftypefn
4865
4866@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
b3c144a3 4867This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
7d69de61
RH
4868stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4869involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4870
4871The default version of this hook invokes a function called
083cad55 4872@samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
7d69de61
RH
4873normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4874@end deftypefn
4875
677f3fa8 4876@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
d5fabb58 4877Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
7458026b
ILT
4878@end deftypefn
4879
aaeaa9a9
RO
4880@node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4881@subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4882@cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4883
4884@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
73b3e61b
TV
4885Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4886clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4887That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4888linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4889modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4890in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4891The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
1e288103 4892is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
aaeaa9a9
RO
4893@end deftypevr
4894
feca2ed3
JW
4895@node Varargs
4896@section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4897@cindex varargs implementation
4898
aee96fe9
JM
4899GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4900@code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
feca2ed3
JW
4901on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4902varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4903conditionals to include it.
4904
aee96fe9 4905ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
feca2ed3
JW
4906the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4907implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5490d604 4908to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
feca2ed3
JW
4909@code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4910supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4911
4912However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4913the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4914below.
4915
a2c4f8e0 4916@defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
feca2ed3 4917Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5490d604 4918that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
feca2ed3 4919versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
c2379679 4920you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
feca2ed3
JW
4921
4922On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
f61c92c3
KH
4923control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4924other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4925found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
feca2ed3
JW
4926
4927Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4928beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4929@code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4930This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4931to use them for its own purposes.
4932@c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4933@c 10feb93
a2c4f8e0 4934@end defmac
feca2ed3 4935
a2c4f8e0 4936@defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
c59a0a1d 4937This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
767094dd 4938argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
feca2ed3
JW
4939returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4940argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4941fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4942verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4943of the current function.
a2c4f8e0 4944@end defmac
feca2ed3 4945
a2c4f8e0 4946@defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
feca2ed3
JW
4947Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4948passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4949has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4950specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4951with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4952
4953@code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4954considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4955kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4956
4957The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4958interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
a2c4f8e0 4959@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
4960
4961These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4962
61f71b34
DD
4963@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4964If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4965@code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4966beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4967return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4968to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4969@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 4970
ef4bddc2 4971@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
61f71b34
DD
4972This target hook offers an alternative to using
4973@code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4974@code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4975register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4976have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4977use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4978pass all their arguments on the stack.
feca2ed3 4979
61f71b34 4980The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
8760eaae 4981structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
feca2ed3
JW
4982named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4983last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4984
61f71b34
DD
4985The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4986argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4987store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4988variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4989store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4990frame.
feca2ed3
JW
4991
4992Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4993compile time without knowing their data types,
61f71b34
DD
4994@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4995have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4996for all data types.
feca2ed3
JW
4997
4998If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4999arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5000happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
61f71b34 5001end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
feca2ed3 5002not generate any instructions in this case.
61f71b34 5003@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5004
d5cc9181 5005@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
61f71b34 5006Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
e5e809f4 5007argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
feca2ed3 5008
b25b9e8f 5009This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
61f71b34
DD
5010is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5011@code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5012arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5b4ef0b1 5013but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
61f71b34
DD
5014then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5015except the last are treated as named.
e5e809f4 5016
9ddb66ef 5017You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
61f71b34 5018@end deftypefn
9ab70a9b 5019
2f21e1ba
BS
5020@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5021While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5022for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5023@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5024before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5025function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5026@code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5027invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5028This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5029registers if a target needs it.
5030For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5031passed instead of an argument register.
5032Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5033@end deftypefn
5034
5035@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5036This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5037just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5038signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5039emitted call are now no longer in use.
5040Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5041@end deftypefn
5042
d5cc9181 5043@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
9ab70a9b 5044If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
61f71b34
DD
5045@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5046@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5047defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
c2379679 5048@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
61f71b34
DD
5049Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5050@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5051
d5e254e1
IE
5052@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5053This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5054@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5055bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5056memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5057memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5058constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5059should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5060@end deftypefn
5061
5062@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5063This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5064@var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5065@var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5066memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5067memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5068constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5069should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5070@end deftypefn
5071
5072@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5073This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5074returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5075loaded bounds.
5076@end deftypefn
5077
5078@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5079This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5080returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5081@end deftypefn
5082
5083@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5084Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5085returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5086@code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5087@end deftypefn
5088
5089@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5090Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5091into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5092@code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5093@end deftypefn
5094
feca2ed3
JW
5095@node Trampolines
5096@section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5097@cindex trampolines for nested functions
5098@cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5099
5100A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5101when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5102the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
a3a15b4d 5103tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
feca2ed3
JW
5104trampoline.
5105
5106The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5107address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5108the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5109two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5110exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5111machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5112two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5113operands.
5114
5115The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5116parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5117immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5118simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5119proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5120may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5121separately.
5122
531ca746
RH
5123@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5124This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5125on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5126the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5127label---the label is taken care of automatically.
feca2ed3 5128
531ca746
RH
5129If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5130for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
feca2ed3
JW
5131code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5132to generate it on the spot.
531ca746 5133@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5134
a2c4f8e0 5135@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
d6b5193b
RS
5136Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5137(@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
a2c4f8e0 5138@end defmac
feca2ed3 5139
a2c4f8e0 5140@defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
feca2ed3 5141A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
a2c4f8e0 5142@end defmac
feca2ed3 5143
a2c4f8e0 5144@defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
feca2ed3
JW
5145Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5146
531ca746 5147If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
feca2ed3 5148is used for aligning trampolines.
a2c4f8e0 5149@end defmac
feca2ed3 5150
531ca746
RH
5151@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5152This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5153@var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5154is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
feca2ed3
JW
5155RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5156when it is called.
5157
531ca746
RH
5158If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5159first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5160from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
ff2ce160 5161Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
531ca746
RH
5162trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5163to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
b33493e3 5164
531ca746 5165If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
ff2ce160 5166enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
531ca746
RH
5167initializing the trampoline proper.
5168@end deftypefn
5169
5170@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5171This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5172the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5173memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5174the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5175address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5176be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5177If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5178@end deftypefn
feca2ed3
JW
5179
5180Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5181separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5182fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5183jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5184
5185Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5186the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5187make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5188subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5189latter makes initialization faster.
5190
5191To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
f691dc3b 5192the following macro.
feca2ed3 5193
a2c4f8e0 5194@defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
feca2ed3 5195If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
f691dc3b
AJ
5196cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5197typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5198@var{end} are both pointer expressions.
a2c4f8e0 5199@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5200
5201To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5202you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5203cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5204beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5205its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5206
a2c4f8e0 5207@defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
feca2ed3
JW
5208Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5209work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
161d7b59 5210which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
feca2ed3
JW
5211@code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5212
5213If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5214C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5215special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5216statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5217global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5218special assembler code.
a2c4f8e0 5219@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5220
5221@node Library Calls
5222@section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5223@cindex library subroutine names
5224@cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5225
5226@c prevent bad page break with this line
5227Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5228
a2c4f8e0 5229@defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
d8088c6f
BS
5230This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5231expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
2dd76960 5232provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
d8088c6f 5233are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
a2c4f8e0 5234@end defmac
d8088c6f 5235
c15c90bb 5236@findex set_optab_libfunc
914d25dc 5237@findex init_one_libfunc
c15c90bb
ZW
5238@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5239This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5240existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5241@code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5242@code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5243library routines.
feca2ed3 5244
c15c90bb
ZW
5245The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5246@end deftypefn
c5c60e15 5247
cdbf4541
BS
5248@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5249If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5250underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5251instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5252currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5253is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5254@code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5255@end deftypevr
5256
9c917669 5257@defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
c15c90bb
ZW
5258This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5259implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5260mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5261return a tristate.
5262
5263GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5264comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5265don't need to define this macro.
5266@end defmac
5267
b3f8d95d
MM
5268@defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5269This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5270functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5271operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5272and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
38b974a6 5273If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
78466c0e 5274@minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
b3f8d95d
MM
5275in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5276@end defmac
5277
30b8f78b
KV
5278@defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5279This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5280instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5281make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5282division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5283make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5284@end defmac
5285
feca2ed3 5286@cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5287@findex matherr
5288@defmac TARGET_EDOM
feca2ed3 5289The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
a3a15b4d 5290expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
feca2ed3
JW
5291deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5292@file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5293system.
5294
5295If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5296domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5297error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5298there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5299that @code{matherr} is used normally.
a2c4f8e0 5300@end defmac
feca2ed3 5301
feca2ed3 5302@cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
a2c4f8e0 5303@defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
feca2ed3
JW
5304Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5305refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5306@code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5307macro, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 5308@end defmac
feca2ed3 5309
d33d9e47
AI
5310@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5311This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5312@var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5313@end deftypefn
006339cd 5314
a2c4f8e0 5315@defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
fea3ca91
IS
5316Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5317by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5318and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5319This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5320the NeXT runtime installed.
5321
5322If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5323will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5324selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5325
5326In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5327scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
a2c4f8e0 5328@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
5329
5330@node Addressing Modes
5331@section Addressing Modes
5332@cindex addressing modes
5333
5334@c prevent bad page break with this line
5335This is about addressing modes.
5336
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5337@defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5338@defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5339@defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5340@defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
df2a54e9 5341A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
7a6bd5ae 5342pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
a2c4f8e0 5343@end defmac
feca2ed3 5344
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5345@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5346@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
df2a54e9 5347A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae
JL
5348post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5349the size of the memory operand.
a2c4f8e0 5350@end defmac
864bcaa7 5351
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5352@defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5353@defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
df2a54e9 5354A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
7a6bd5ae 5355post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
a2c4f8e0 5356@end defmac
864bcaa7 5357
a2c4f8e0 5358@defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3 5359A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
65a324b4
NC
5360is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5361@code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5362is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
ff2ce160 5363constant addresses are supported.
a2c4f8e0 5364@end defmac
feca2ed3 5365
a2c4f8e0
ZW
5366@defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5367@code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5368accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5369known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5370expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5371@code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5372@end defmac
feca2ed3 5373
a2c4f8e0 5374@defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
feca2ed3
JW
5375A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5376memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
c6c3dba9 5377the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
feca2ed3 5378accept.
a2c4f8e0 5379@end defmac
feca2ed3 5380
ef4bddc2 5381@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
c6c3dba9
PB
5382A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5383address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
feca2ed3 5384
c6c3dba9 5385Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
914d25dc 5386non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
c6c3dba9 5387desired by the caller.
feca2ed3 5388
c6c3dba9
PB
5389The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5390that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5391considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5392kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5393must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5394up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5395register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5396if the array holds @code{-1}.
feca2ed3
JW
5397
5398The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5399accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5400register is required.
5401
feca2ed3
JW
5402Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5403and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5404constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5405specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5406recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5407
5408Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5409sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5410@code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5411naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5412be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5413
fb49053f 5414@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
feca2ed3
JW
5415On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5416the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
fb49053f
RH
5417target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5418into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
feca2ed3
JW
5419@code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5420@code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5421Format}.
c6c3dba9
PB
5422
5423@cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5424Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5425this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5426has this syntax:
5427
5428@example
5429#define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5430@end example
5431
5432@noindent
5433and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5434address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
6f7b223b
PK
5435
5436@findex REG_OK_STRICT
5437Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5438macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5439@code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5440that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5441
c6c3dba9
PB
5442Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5443files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5444@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5445
a4edaf83
AK
5446@defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5447A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5448character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5449letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
c6c3dba9 5450@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
a4edaf83
AK
5451support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5452semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5453preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5454@code{'m'} constraint.
5455@end defmac
5456
a2c4f8e0 5457@defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
a9e6fc5a
RS
5458A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5459or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
53451050
RS
5460can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5461@code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
b949ea8b
JW
5462
5463It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5464that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5465
5466The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
161d7b59 5467a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
a2c4f8e0 5468@end defmac
b949ea8b 5469
ef4bddc2 5470@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
506d7b68
PB
5471This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5472operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5473address.
feca2ed3
JW
5474
5475@findex break_out_memory_refs
5476@var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5477and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5478@var{x}.
5479
506d7b68 5480The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
feca2ed3 5481@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
506d7b68 5482should return the new @var{x}.
feca2ed3 5483
f938987f
HPN
5484It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5485with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5486The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5487the target supports only emulated TLS, it
506d7b68
PB
5488is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5489a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5490strategy can generate better code.
5491@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5492
a2c4f8e0 5493@defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
a9a2595b
JR
5494A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5495that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5496@var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5497It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
02f52e19 5498performance reasons.
a9a2595b
JR
5499
5500For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5501reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5502registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5503processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5504needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
aee96fe9 5505@code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
a9a2595b
JR
5506generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5507be shared.
5508
39bdfaa0
RH
5509@emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5510to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5511and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5512of reload internals.
a9a2595b 5513
5f0c590d
JL
5514@emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5515previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5516then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5517
a9a2595b 5518@findex push_reload
39bdfaa0
RH
5519The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5520need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5521suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
a9a2595b 5522
39bdfaa0 5523The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
a9a2595b
JR
5524@var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5525should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5526This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5527@code{push_reload}.
5528
39bdfaa0
RH
5529@findex strict_memory_address_p
5530The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5531the address has become legitimate.
5532
a9a2595b
JR
5533@findex copy_rtx
5534If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
ab873839 5535this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
a9a2595b 5536single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
c771326b 5537top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
a9a2595b
JR
5538It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5539address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
a2c4f8e0 5540@end defmac
a9a2595b 5541
5bfed9a9
GJL
5542@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5543This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5544space @var{addrspace} can have
cbda7dc6
AS
5545different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5546reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5547but not others.
5548
5549Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5550effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5551of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5552addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5553
5554You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5555
5556The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5557@end deftypefn
5558
ef4bddc2 5559@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
1a627b35
RS
5560This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5561@var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5562@var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5563
5564The default definition returns true.
5565@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 5566
73f8783a
RS
5567@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5568This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5569@code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5570macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5571references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5572addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5573the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5574into their original form.
5575@end deftypefn
93bcc8c9
JJ
5576
5577@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5578This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5579debug sections.
5580@end deftypefn
73f8783a 5581
ef4bddc2 5582@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
d3da4d14 5583This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
fbbf66e7
RS
5584should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5585of @var{x}.
5586
5587The default version of this hook returns false.
d3da4d14
RH
5588
5589The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5590deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5591from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5592holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5593of TLS symbols for various targets.
5594@end deftypefn
5595
ef4bddc2 5596@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885
RS
5597This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5598be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5599of @var{x}.
5600
5601The default version returns false for all constants.
5602@end deftypefn
5603
361a58da
DE
5604@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5605This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5606be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5607
5608The default version returns true for all decls.
5609@end deftypefn
5610
5eb7ce91 5611@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (unsigned @var{fn}, bool @var{md_fn}, bool @var{sqrt})
6b889d89 5612This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements reciprocal of
ac10986f 5613the builtin function with builtin function code @var{fn}, or
5eb7ce91 5614@code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available. @var{md_fn} is true
ac10986f
UB
5615when @var{fn} is a code of a machine-dependent builtin function. When
5616@var{sqrt} is true, additional optimizations that apply only to the reciprocal
5617of a square root function are performed, and only reciprocals of @code{sqrt}
5618function are valid.
6b889d89
UB
5619@end deftypefn
5620
d16b59fa
DN
5621@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5622This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5623address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
083cad55 5624used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
d16b59fa
DN
5625@var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5626
ab873839 5627The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
d16b59fa
DN
5628@var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5629the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5630@code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5631two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5632@var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5633the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5634from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
083cad55
EC
5635@var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5636@var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
d16b59fa
DN
5637@var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5638
5639If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5640to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5641use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5642@code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
083cad55 5643should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
d16b59fa
DN
5644described above.
5645If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5646the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
8ad1dde7 5647log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
d16b59fa
DN
5648@end deftypefn
5649
720f5239 5650@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
35e1a5e7 5651Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
ff2ce160 5652For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
720f5239 5653misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
a934eb2d
JR
5654@end deftypefn
5655
5656@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5657Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5658@end deftypefn
5659
ef4bddc2 5660@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5dea5b2a 5661Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
a934eb2d
JR
5662@end deftypefn
5663
88dd7150 5664@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
f57d17f1 5665This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
88dd7150 5666input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
a934eb2d
JR
5667The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5668specifies how the conversion is to be applied
f57d17f1
TM
5669(truncation, rounding, etc.).
5670
5671If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5672@code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5673conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5674@end deftypefn
5675
62f7fd21
MM
5676@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5677This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5678vectorized variant of the builtin function with builtin function code
5679@var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5680The value of @var{fndecl} is the builtin function declaration. The
5681return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5682@var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
2505a3f2
RG
5683@end deftypefn
5684
ef4bddc2 5685@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
0601d0cf
RE
5686This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5687store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5688parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5689the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5690parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5691@end deftypefn
5692
ef4bddc2 5693@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
cc4b5170
RG
5694This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5695mode @var{mode}. The default is
5696equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
26983c22
L
5697transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5698@end deftypefn
5699
767f865f
RG
5700@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5701This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5702after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5703mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5704The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5705@end deftypefn
5706
9f47c7e5
IE
5707@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5708This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5709of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5710vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5711@end deftypefn
5712
c3e7ee41 5713@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
92345349 5714This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
c3e7ee41
BS
5715@end deftypefn
5716
92345349
BS
5717@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5718This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
c3e7ee41
BS
5719@end deftypefn
5720
92345349
BS
5721@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5722This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
c3e7ee41
BS
5723@end deftypefn
5724
5725@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5726This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5727@end deftypefn
5728
0a35513e
AH
5729@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_LOAD (tree)
5730This hook should return the built-in decl needed to load a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5731@end deftypefn
5732
5733@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_TM_STORE (tree)
5734This hook should return the built-in decl needed to store a vector of the given type within a transaction.
5735@end deftypefn
5736
aec7ae7d
JJ
5737@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5738Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5739is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5740the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5741The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5742loads.
5743@end deftypefn
5744
3bab6342
AT
5745@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5746Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5747is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5748the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5749The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5750stores.
5751@end deftypefn
5752
0136f8f0
AH
5753@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5754This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5755fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5756@var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5757The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5758or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5759@end deftypefn
5760
5761@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5762This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5763to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5764@end deftypefn
5765
5766@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5767This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5768in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5769usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5770to use it.
5771@end deftypefn
5772
6e91acf8 5773@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
94829f87
NS
5774This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5775compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
5776and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
5777function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
5778outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. It
5779should fill in anything that needs to default to non-unity and verify
5780non-defaults. Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
5781true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5782provide dimensions larger than 1.
5783@end deftypefn
5784
bd751975
NS
5785@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5786This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5787or zero if unbounded.
5788@end deftypefn
5789
6e91acf8 5790@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
9bd46bc9
NS
5791This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5792function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5793should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5794It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5795return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5796gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5797The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
6e91acf8
NS
5798@end deftypefn
5799
e5014671
NS
5800@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5801This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5802@var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5803instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5804the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5805expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5806for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5807@end deftypefn
5808
aacd3885
RS
5809@node Anchored Addresses
5810@section Anchored Addresses
5811@cindex anchored addresses
5812@cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5813
5814GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5815For example, if we have:
5816
5817@smallexample
5818static int a, b, c;
5819int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5820@end smallexample
5821
5822the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5823addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5824it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5825the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5826be something like:
5827
5828@smallexample
5829int foo (void)
5830@{
5831 register int *xr = &x;
5832 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5833@}
5834@end smallexample
5835
5836(which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5837``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5838
5839The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5840in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5841section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5842or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5843
9e3be889 5844@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5845The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5846On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5847applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5848for every mode. The default value is 0.
9e3be889 5849@end deftypevr
aacd3885 5850
9e3be889 5851@deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
aacd3885
RS
5852Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5853offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5854value is 0.
9e3be889 5855@end deftypevr
aacd3885
RS
5856
5857@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5858Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5859@code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5860The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5861of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5862
5863If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5864it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5865If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5866is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5867@end deftypefn
5868
b6fd8800 5869@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
aacd3885 5870Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3fa9c136 5871@var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
aacd3885
RS
5872@samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5873
5874The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5875intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5876or target-specific sections.
5877@end deftypefn
5878
feca2ed3
JW
5879@node Condition Code
5880@section Condition Code Status
5881@cindex condition code status
5882
f90b7a5a
PB
5883The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5884two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5885
5886The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5887(@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5888clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5889register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5890architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5891most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5892most RISC machines.
5893
5894The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
728acca0
MP
5895the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5896and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5897arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5898Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5899the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5900
5901These restrictions can prevent important
f90b7a5a
PB
5902optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5903is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5904three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5905scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5906separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5907
5908For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5909represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5910condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5911condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5912or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5913Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5914that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5915
5916Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5917specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5918interested in most macros in this section.
5919
5920@menu
5921* CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5922* MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
f90b7a5a
PB
5923@end menu
5924
5925@node CC0 Condition Codes
5926@subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5927@findex cc0
feca2ed3
JW
5928
5929@findex cc_status
5930The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5931describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5932the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5933variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5934currently based, and several standard flags.
5935
5936Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5937description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5938information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5939
a2c4f8e0 5940@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
feca2ed3
JW
5941C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5942component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5943
5944This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5945@end defmac
feca2ed3 5946
a2c4f8e0 5947@defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
feca2ed3
JW
5948A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5949The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5950the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5951define this macro to initialize it.
5952
5953This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
a2c4f8e0 5954@end defmac
feca2ed3 5955
a2c4f8e0 5956@defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
5957A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5958appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5959this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5960code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5961set @code{(cc0)}.
5962
5963This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5964
5965If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5966other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5967invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5968reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5969registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5970@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5971insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5972based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5973value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5974this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5975@samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5976@code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5977condition code value.
5978
5979The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5980with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5981@code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5982constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5983insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5984@code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5985@code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5986
5987A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5988that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5989@samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5990two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
a2c4f8e0 5991@end defmac
feca2ed3 5992
f90b7a5a
PB
5993@node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5994@subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5995@findex CCmode
5996@findex MODE_CC
5997
a2c4f8e0 5998@defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
f90b7a5a
PB
5999On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6000than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6001code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6002when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6003bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6004branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6005this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6006record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6007also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6008unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6009
6010If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6011@file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6012a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6013have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6014by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6015be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6016the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6017
6018@smallexample
6019(define_insn ""
6020 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6021 (compare:CC_NOOV
6022 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6023 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6024 (const_int 0)))]
6025 ""
6026 "@dots{}")
6027@end smallexample
6028
6029@noindent
6030together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6031for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
feca2ed3
JW
6032
6033@smallexample
6034#define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
95cc11e1
EB
6035 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6036 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6037 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6038 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6039 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
feca2ed3
JW
6040 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6041@end smallexample
6042
f90b7a5a
PB
6043Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6044were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6045this section.
6046
94134f42
ZW
6047You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6048in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
a2c4f8e0 6049@end defmac
feca2ed3 6050
d331d374 6051@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
8760eaae 6052On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
feca2ed3
JW
6053convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6054does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6055comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6056
c354951b
AK
6057On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6058@var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6059are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6060@var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6061allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6062in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6063allowed to swap operands in that case.
feca2ed3 6064
a3a15b4d 6065GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
feca2ed3
JW
6066valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6067@file{md} file.
6068
c354951b
AK
6069You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6070comparison code or operands.
6071@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 6072
a2c4f8e0 6073@defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
feca2ed3
JW
6074A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6075comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6076can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6077then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6078
6079You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6080floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
981f6289 6081For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
95cc11e1 6082inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
feca2ed3
JW
6083
6084@smallexample
95cc11e1
EB
6085#define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6086 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
feca2ed3 6087@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6088@end defmac
feca2ed3 6089
a2c4f8e0 6090@defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
9e7adcb3
JH
6091A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6092comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6093@code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6094machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6095instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
95cc11e1 6096freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
9e7adcb3
JH
6097like:
6098
6099@smallexample
6100#define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
c771326b 6101 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
9e7adcb3
JH
6102 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6103@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 6104@end defmac
9e7adcb3 6105
ab7e224a 6106@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
e129d93a
ILT
6107On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6108register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6109regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6110hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6111small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6112to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6113arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6114When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
ab7e224a 6115integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
e129d93a
ILT
6116@code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6117
6118The default version of this hook returns false.
6119@end deftypefn
6120
ef4bddc2 6121@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
e129d93a
ILT
6122On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6123@code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6124validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6125target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6126both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6127return @code{VOIDmode}.
6128
6129The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6130same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6131returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6132@end deftypefn
6133
8f048116
EB
6134@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6135If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6136@end deftypevr
6137
feca2ed3
JW
6138@node Costs
6139@section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6140@cindex costs of instructions
6141@cindex relative costs
6142@cindex speed of instructions
6143
6144These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6145on the target machine.
6146
a2c4f8e0 6147@defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
e56b4594
AO
6148A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6149register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6150expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6151value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6152that.
feca2ed3
JW
6153
6154It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6155same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6156registers if they are not general registers.
6157
6158If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6159hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6160classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6161constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6162allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6163if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
de8f4b07
AS
6164
6165These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6166@code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6167@end defmac
feca2ed3 6168
ef4bddc2 6169@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
de8f4b07
AS
6170This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6171from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6172are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6173A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6174that.
6175
6176It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6177same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6178registers if they are not general registers.
6179
6180If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6181hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6182classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6183constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6184allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6185if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6186
6187The default version of this function returns 2.
6188@end deftypefn
6189
a2c4f8e0 6190@defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
cbd5b9a2
KR
6191A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6192register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
df2a54e9 6193is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
473fe49b
KR
6194is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6195registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6196should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6197
a3a15b4d 6198If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
38e01259 6199the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
473fe49b
KR
6200needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6201between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6202more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6203reflect the actual cost of the move.
6204
a3a15b4d 6205GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
473fe49b
KR
6206secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6207a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6208secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62094 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6210value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6211are the same as to this macro.
f5c21ef3
AS
6212
6213These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6214@code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
a2c4f8e0 6215@end defmac
cbd5b9a2 6216
ef4bddc2 6217@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
f5c21ef3 6218This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
911852ff 6219between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
f5c21ef3 6220if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
de8f4b07
AS
6221This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6222If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6223registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
f5c21ef3
AS
6224
6225If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6226the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6227needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
911852ff 6228between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
f5c21ef3
AS
6229more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6230reflect the actual cost of the move.
6231
6232GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6233secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6234a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6235secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
62364 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6237value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6238are the same as to this target hook.
6239@end deftypefn
6240
3a4fd356 6241@defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
525d13b0
MS
6242A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6243the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6244@var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6245for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6246optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6247true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6248@code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
a2c4f8e0 6249@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
6250
6251Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
a3a15b4d 6252but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
feca2ed3
JW
6253ordinarily expect.
6254
a2c4f8e0 6255@defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
feca2ed3 6256Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
e979f9e8 6257than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
feca2ed3
JW
6258faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6259require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6260between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6261
6262When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6263finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6264load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6265faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6266may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6267other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
a2c4f8e0 6268@end defmac
feca2ed3 6269
a2c4f8e0 6270@defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
5fad8ebf
DE
6271Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6272@var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6273than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6274handler.
feca2ed3 6275
df2a54e9
JM
6276When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6277@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
feca2ed3 6278moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
df2a54e9 6279Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
feca2ed3
JW
6280cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6281
6be57663 6282If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
df2a54e9
JM
6283this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6284@code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
a2c4f8e0 6285@end defmac
feca2ed3 6286
65a324b4 6287@defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
9862dea9 6288The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
c5c76735 6289which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
feca2ed3
JW
6290string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6291make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6292
c5c76735
JL
6293Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6294@code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6295the number of such sequences.
9862dea9 6296
65a324b4
NC
6297The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6298optimized for speed rather than size.
6299
feca2ed3 6300If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6301@end defmac
feca2ed3 6302
445d7826 6303@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
7cbed008
JG
6304GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6305two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6306when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6307implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6308insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6309@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6310unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6311
6312This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6313given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6314infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6315Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6316units.
6317
6318The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6319@code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES}.
6320These describe the type of memory operation under consideration.
6321
6322The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6323optimized for speed rather than size.
6324
6325Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6326for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6327@code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6328@code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6329insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6330the body of the memory operation.
6331
6332Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6333in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6334move would be greater than that of a library call.
6335@end deftypefn
6336
a2c4f8e0 6337@defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
fbe1758d 6338A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6e01bd94 6339a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
a2c4f8e0 6340@end defmac
fbe1758d 6341
65a324b4 6342@defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
78762e3b
RS
6343The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6344of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6345or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6346eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6347
65a324b4
NC
6348The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6349optimized for speed rather than size.
6350
78762e3b 6351If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
a2c4f8e0 6352@end defmac
78762e3b 6353
65a324b4 6354@defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
cfa31150
SL
6355The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6356of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
ff2ce160 6357a block set insn or a library call.
cfa31150
SL
6358Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6359eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6360
65a324b4
NC
6361The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6362optimized for speed rather than size.
6363
cfa31150
SL
6364If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6365@end defmac
6366
a2c4f8e0 6367@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6368A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6369thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6370@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6371@end defmac
6e01bd94 6372
a2c4f8e0 6373@defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6374A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6375thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6377@end defmac
fbe1758d 6378
a2c4f8e0 6379@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6380A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6381thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6382@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6383@end defmac
6e01bd94 6384
a2c4f8e0 6385@defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6386A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6387thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6388@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6389@end defmac
fbe1758d 6390
a2c4f8e0 6391@defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6392A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6393thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6394@code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6395@end defmac
6e01bd94 6396
a2c4f8e0 6397@defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
c771326b 6398A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6e01bd94
MH
6399thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6400@code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6401@end defmac
fbe1758d 6402
a2c4f8e0 6403@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6404This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6405thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6406@code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6407@end defmac
6e01bd94 6408
a2c4f8e0 6409@defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6e01bd94
MH
6410This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6411thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6412@code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
a2c4f8e0 6413@end defmac
fbe1758d 6414
a2c4f8e0 6415@defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
1e8552c2 6416Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
feca2ed3 6417function address than to call an address kept in a register.
a2c4f8e0 6418@end defmac
feca2ed3 6419
a8d56c30
SB
6420@defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6421Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6422@samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6423@code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6424@end defmac
6425
e548c9df 6426@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
3c50106f
RH
6427This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6428
6429The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
68f932c4
RS
6430available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6431as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6432That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6433that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6434either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6435(b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6436
e548c9df
AM
6437@var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6438do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
3c50106f
RH
6439
6440In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6441@code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6442instructions.
6443
6444On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6445for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
31a52b86
RS
6446necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6447for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6448operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6449
65a324b4
NC
6450When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6451false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
31a52b86 6452size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
3c50106f
RH
6453
6454The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6455processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6456@end deftypefn
6457
ef4bddc2 6458@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
10154ff8
RH
6459This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6460@var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6461the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6462
6463For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6464true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6465instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6466all addresses will have equal costs.
6467
6468In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6469the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6470cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6471
6472For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6473and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6474is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6475references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6476the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6477that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6478instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6479specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6480
6481This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6482
6483On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6484cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6485@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6486be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6487@code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6488should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6489should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6490registers on machines with lots of registers.
6491@end deftypefn
6492
f52a73a4
SD
6493@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6494This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6495speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6496such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6497delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6498disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6499delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6500as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6501@end deftypefn
6502
c237e94a
ZW
6503@node Scheduling
6504@section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6505
6506The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6507adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6508hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6509them: try the first ones in this list first.
6510
6511@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
fae15c93
VM
6512This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6513issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6514Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6515an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6516constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6517hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6518This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6519it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
c237e94a
ZW
6520@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6521@end deftypefn
6522
ac44248e 6523@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
c237e94a
ZW
6524This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6525from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
3ee04299
DE
6526still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6527@samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6528@code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6529You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6530than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6531@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6532debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6533@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6534was scheduled.
c237e94a
ZW
6535@end deftypefn
6536
ac44248e 6537@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
fae15c93
VM
6538This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6539relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6540dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6541is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6542to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
c237e94a 6543that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
fae15c93
VM
6544data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6545description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6546output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6547times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6548acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
fa0aee89 6549@pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
c237e94a
ZW
6550@end deftypefn
6551
ac44248e 6552@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
c237e94a 6553This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
496d7bb0
MK
6554@var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6555execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
c237e94a
ZW
6556later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6557scheduling priorities of insns.
6558@end deftypefn
6559
ce1ce33a 6560@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6561This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6562list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6563combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6564@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6565debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6566@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6567list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6568a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6569reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
65a324b4 6570@var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
c237e94a
ZW
6571is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6572the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6573can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6574@samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6575@end deftypefn
6576
ce1ce33a 6577@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
c237e94a
ZW
6578Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6579function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6580is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6581@samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6582return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6583this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6584scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6585cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6586@end deftypefn
6587
0dc41f28
WM
6588@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6589This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6590@end deftypefn
6591
892d9879
KT
6592@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6593This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6594a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6595(@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6596group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6597two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6598validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
0dc41f28
WM
6599@end deftypefn
6600
ce1ce33a 6601@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
30028c85
VM
6602This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6603chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6604correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6605example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6606analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6607dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6608calculated.
6609@end deftypefn
6610
c237e94a
ZW
6611@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6612This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6613instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6614pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6615is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6616@var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6617region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
431ae0bf 6618scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
c237e94a
ZW
6619@end deftypefn
6620
6621@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6622This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6623instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6624cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6625is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6626to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6627@option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6628@end deftypefn
6629
58565a33
SKG
6630@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6631This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6632@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6633@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6634@var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6635@end deftypefn
6636
6637@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
8a36672b 6638This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
58565a33
SKG
6639@var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6640@var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6641@end deftypefn
6642
914d25dc 6643@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6644The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6645pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6646when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6647simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6648processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6649based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6650when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6651@end deftypefn
6652
6653@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6654The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6655@end deftypefn
6656
ac44248e 6657@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
fae15c93
VM
6658The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6659to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6660simulated processor cycle finishes.
6661@end deftypefn
6662
6663@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6664The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6665used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6666@end deftypefn
6667
914d25dc 6668@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6669The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6670The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6671to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6672state on a single insn is not enough.
6673@end deftypefn
6674
914d25dc 6675@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
1c3d0d93
MK
6676The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6677The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
021efafc 6678to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
1c3d0d93
MK
6679state on a single insn is not enough.
6680@end deftypefn
6681
fae15c93
VM
6682@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6683This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6684for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6685chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6686value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6687@samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6688subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6689maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6690@acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6691packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6692rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6693
6694This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6695processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6696with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6697@var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6698@var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6699processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6700@var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6701until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6702the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6703
6704Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6705pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6706schedules to choose the best one.
6707
6708The default is no multipass scheduling.
6709@end deftypefn
6710
ac44248e 6711@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
30028c85
VM
6712
6713This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6714considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
4960a0cb
MK
6715zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6716Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6717the current round of multipass scheduling.
6718Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6719number of cycles.
6720Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6721instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6722to allow backends make correct judgements.
30028c85 6723
62b9c42c 6724The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
30028c85
VM
6725@end deftypefn
6726
4960a0cb 6727@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
894fd6f2
MK
6728This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6729scheduling.
6730@end deftypefn
6731
ac44248e 6732@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
894fd6f2
MK
6733This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6734@end deftypefn
6735
4960a0cb 6736@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
894fd6f2
MK
6737This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6738an instruction.
6739@end deftypefn
6740
6741@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6742This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6743round of multipass scheduling.
6744@end deftypefn
6745
6746@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6747This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6748@end deftypefn
6749
6750@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
2b0d3573 6751This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
894fd6f2
MK
6752@end deftypefn
6753
ac44248e 6754@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
a934eb2d
JR
6755This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6756on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6757@var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6758the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6759is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6760start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6761verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6762@var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6763processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6764and the current processor cycle.
30028c85
VM
6765@end deftypefn
6766
72392b81 6767@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
569fa502 6768This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
daf2f129 6769the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
569fa502 6770are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
b198261f
MK
6771to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6772being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
72392b81 6773dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
daf2f129 6774parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
569fa502
DN
6775The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6776insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6777and @code{false} otherwise.
6778
6779Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
daf2f129 6780where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
569fa502 6781delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
daf2f129 6782that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
569fa502 6783important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
78466c0e 6784closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
72392b81 6785not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
569fa502
DN
6786@end deftypefn
6787
496d7bb0
MK
6788@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6789This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6790the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6791per instruction data structures.
6792@end deftypefn
6793
b6fd8800 6794@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
e855c69d
AB
6795Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6796@end deftypefn
6797
6798@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6799Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6800It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
ab7e224a 6801beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
e855c69d
AB
6802@end deftypefn
6803
6804@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
914d25dc 6805Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
e855c69d
AB
6806@end deftypefn
6807
6808@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6809Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6810@end deftypefn
6811
6812@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6813Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6814@end deftypefn
6815
ac44248e 6816@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
64ee9490
EC
6817This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6818speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6819The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6820version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6821pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
8ad1dde7 6822or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
496d7bb0
MK
6823speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6824the generated speculative pattern.
6825@end deftypefn
6826
8e90de43 6827@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
496d7bb0 6828This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
72392b81
JR
6829for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6830instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
496d7bb0
MK
6831@end deftypefn
6832
ac44248e 6833@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
496d7bb0 6834This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
64ee9490
EC
6835check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6836speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6837@var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6838be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6839recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6840a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
496d7bb0
MK
6841@var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6842@end deftypefn
6843
50e87e30 6844@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
64ee9490 6845This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
50e87e30
JR
6846enabled/used.
6847The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
496d7bb0
MK
6848The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6849@end deftypefn
6850
67186a97
TS
6851@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6852This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6853resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6854the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6855backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6856bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6857of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6858@end deftypefn
6859
ac44248e 6860@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7942e47e
RY
6861This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6862is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6863@end deftypefn
6864
ac44248e 6865@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7942e47e
RY
6866This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6867in its second parameter.
6868@end deftypefn
6869
b0bd15f7
BS
6870@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6871True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6872the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6873also the latencies of operations.
6874@end deftypevr
6875
ef4bddc2 6876@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
df7b0cc4
EI
6877This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6878parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6879@end deftypefn
6880
b16abbcb
BC
6881@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
6882This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
6883priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
6884are returned via pointer parameters.
6885
6886@var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
6887@var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
6888@var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
6889fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
6890@var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
6891should be calculated and returned.
6892
6893Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
6894be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
6895instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
6896sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
6897scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
6898should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
6899false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
6900scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
6901instructions.
6902
6903Given below example:
6904
51be4977 6905@smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6906 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6907 add r4, r4, r10
6908 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6909 sub r5, r5, r15
6910 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6911 add r4, r4, r11
6912 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6913 sub r5, r5, r16
51be4977 6914@end smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6915
6916On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
6917merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
6918loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
6919this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
6920instruction based on its fustion type, like:
6921
51be4977
BC
6922@smallexample
6923 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
6924 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6925 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
6926 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6927 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
6928 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6929 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
6930 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6931@end smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6932
6933Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
6934to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
6935pushed together in instruction flow, like:
6936
51be4977 6937@smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6938 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6939 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6940 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6941 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6942 add r4, r4, r10
6943 sub r5, r5, r15
6944 add r4, r4, r11
6945 sub r5, r5, r16
51be4977 6946@end smallexample
b16abbcb
BC
6947
6948Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
6949
6950Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
6951work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
6952
6953This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
6954the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
6955@end deftypefn
6956
feca2ed3
JW
6957@node Sections
6958@section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6959@c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6960@c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6961
6962An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6963data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6964section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6965section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6966section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6967of sections.
6968
d6b5193b
RS
6969@file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6970@code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6971The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6972is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6973as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6974initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6975They may however depend on command-line flags.
6976
6977@emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6978use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6979to be string literals.
6980
6981Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6982section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6983should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6984@code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6985
6986You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6987@code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6988in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6989@code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6990create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6991reuse @code{text_section}.
6992
6993All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
6994if the target does not provide them.
feca2ed3 6995
a2c4f8e0 6996@defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
6997A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
6998assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
6999Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 7000@end defmac
33c09f2f 7001
a2c4f8e0 7002@defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
7003If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7004frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7005a default definition if the target supports named sections.
a2c4f8e0 7006@end defmac
194734e9 7007
a2c4f8e0 7008@defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
194734e9
JH
7009If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7010executed functions in the program.
a2c4f8e0 7011@end defmac
194734e9 7012
a2c4f8e0 7013@defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
7014A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7015assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7016data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
a2c4f8e0 7017@end defmac
feca2ed3 7018
d6b5193b
RS
7019@defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7020If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7021containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7022initialized, writable small data.
7023@end defmac
7024
a2c4f8e0 7025@defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
d48bc59a
RH
7026A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7027assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7028data.
a2c4f8e0 7029@end defmac
d48bc59a 7030
a2c4f8e0 7031@defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
7032If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7033containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
ddf72388 7034uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
07c5f94e 7035@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
047c1c92 7036uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
630d3d5a 7037@option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
047c1c92 7038used.
a2c4f8e0 7039@end defmac
feca2ed3 7040
d6b5193b
RS
7041@defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7042If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7043containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7044uninitialized, writable small data.
7045@end defmac
7046
9b7e6950
RO
7047@defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7048If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7049assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7050common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7051@end defmac
7052
7053@defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7054If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7055containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7056default is @code{'T'}.
7057@end defmac
7058
a2c4f8e0 7059@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
7060If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7061containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7062initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
7063not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7064variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 7065@end defmac
feca2ed3 7066
a2c4f8e0 7067@defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
7068If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7069containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7070finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
98bfa2fb
RS
7071not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7072variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
a2c4f8e0 7073@end defmac
750054a2 7074
7abc66b1
JB
7075@defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7076If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7077containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7078part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7079defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7080both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7081@end defmac
083cad55 7082
7abc66b1
JB
7083@defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7084If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7085containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7086part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7087defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7088both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7089@end defmac
7090
a2c4f8e0 7091@defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
cea3bd3e
RH
7092If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7093via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7094the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7095@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7096to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7097sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
1b2dd04a
AO
7098ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7099registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7100constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 7101@end defmac
1b2dd04a 7102
a0cfeb0f
DD
7103@defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7104If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7105variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7106when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7107you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7108they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7109expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7110MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7111require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7112to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7113access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
726e9992 7114@end defmac
a0cfeb0f 7115
a2c4f8e0 7116@defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
cea3bd3e
RH
7117If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7118arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7119@code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7120and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
a2c4f8e0 7121@end defmac
cea3bd3e 7122
a2c4f8e0 7123@defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
df2a54e9 7124Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
75197b37
BS
7125tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7126section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7127readonly data section is used.
feca2ed3
JW
7128
7129This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
a2c4f8e0 7130@end defmac
feca2ed3 7131
d6b5193b
RS
7132@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7133Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7134@file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7135of its own that you need to create.
7136
7137GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7138any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7139described below.
7140@end deftypefn
7141
914d25dc 7142@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
9b580a0b
RH
7143Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7144selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7145should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7146local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7147
7148The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7149is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7150when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7151in read-only sections even in executables.
7152@end deftypefn
7153
d6b5193b
RS
7154@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7155Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
ae46c4e0
RH
7156assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7157some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7158requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7159local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
d6b5193b 7160@var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
ae46c4e0
RH
7161
7162The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7163variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
09afda70
GK
7164
7165See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
ae46c4e0
RH
7166@end deftypefn
7167
09afda70
GK
7168@defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7169Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7170for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7171
7172In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7173function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7174it is unlikely to be called.
7175@end defmac
7176
ae46c4e0
RH
7177@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7178Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7179and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7180As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7181the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7182
7183The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7184ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7185example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7186Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7187@end deftypefn
7188
d6b5193b
RS
7189@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7190Return the readonly data section associated with
ab5c8549 7191@samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
d6b5193b
RS
7192The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7193the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7194if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7195otherwise.
ab5c8549
JJ
7196@end deftypefn
7197
727a65e6
BS
7198@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7199Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7200section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7201the string if a different section name should be used.
7202@end deftypevr
7203
50b0b78a
IS
7204@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7205Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7206@end deftypefn
7207
ef4bddc2 7208@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
d6b5193b
RS
7209Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7210should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
b64a1b53 7211constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
d6b5193b
RS
7212case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7213in bits.
b64a1b53
RH
7214
7215The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7216constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7217else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7218@end deftypefn
7219
914d25dc 7220@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
5234b8f5
DS
7221Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7222by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7223the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7224or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7225hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7226your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7227returns the @var{id} provided.
7228@end deftypefn
7229
c6a2438a 7230@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
fb49053f
RH
7231Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7232treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7233function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7234
c6a2438a
ZW
7235The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7236@var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7237an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7238rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
0864034e 7239in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
c6a2438a
ZW
7240
7241In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7242a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7243will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7244register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7245rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7246leave it alone.)
fb49053f
RH
7247
7248The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
c6a2438a 7249that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
fb49053f
RH
7250be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7251declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7252declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
c6a2438a 7253@var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
fb49053f
RH
7254
7255@cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
c6a2438a
ZW
7256The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7257@code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7258Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7259encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7260discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7261
7262The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7263in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7264@code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7265before overriding it.
fb49053f
RH
7266@end deftypefn
7267
914d25dc 7268@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
772c5265
RH
7269Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7270the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7271may have added.
7272@end deftypefn
7273
b6fd8800 7274@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7275Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7276The default version of this hook always returns false.
7277@end deftypefn
7278
9e3be889 7279@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
e2a6476e
DE
7280Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7281``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
9e3be889 7282@end deftypevr
e2a6476e 7283
3c5273a9
KT
7284@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7285It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7286
7287The default version of this hook use the target macro
7288@code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7289@end deftypefn
7290
b6fd8800 7291@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
47754fd5
RH
7292Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7293rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7294or executable image).
7295
7296The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7297for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7298currently supported object file formats.
7299@end deftypefn
7300
9e3be889 7301@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
e2a6476e
DE
7302Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7303The default value is false.
9e3be889 7304@end deftypevr
e2a6476e
DE
7305
7306
feca2ed3
JW
7307@node PIC
7308@section Position Independent Code
7309@cindex position independent code
7310@cindex PIC
7311
7312This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7313independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
c6c3dba9
PB
7314generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7315@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7316@code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7317must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7318when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7319need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7320relative addresses.
ff2ce160 7321@c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
feca2ed3
JW
7322@c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7323
a2c4f8e0 7324@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
feca2ed3
JW
7325The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7326data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
161d7b59 7327processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
feca2ed3
JW
7328is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7329pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7330is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
003b9f78 7331necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
12beba6f 7332when @code{flag_pic} is true).
a2c4f8e0 7333@end defmac
feca2ed3 7334
a2c4f8e0 7335@defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
f8fe0a4a
JM
7336A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7337@code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7338the default is zero. Do not define
ed4db1ee 7339this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
a2c4f8e0 7340@end defmac
feca2ed3 7341
a2c4f8e0 7342@defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
7343A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7344operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7345You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7346check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7347check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7348(including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7349position independent code.
a2c4f8e0 7350@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7351
7352@node Assembler Format
7353@section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7354
7355This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
648c546a 7356to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
feca2ed3
JW
7357instructions do.
7358
7359@menu
7360* File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7361* Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7362* Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7363* Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7364* Initialization:: General principles of initialization
6ccde948 7365 and termination routines.
feca2ed3 7366* Macros for Initialization::
6ccde948
RW
7367 Specific macros that control the handling of
7368 initialization and termination routines.
feca2ed3
JW
7369* Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7370* Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7371* Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7372* Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7373@end menu
7374
7375@node File Framework
7376@subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7377@cindex assembler format
7378@cindex output of assembler code
7379
7380@c prevent bad page break with this line
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7381This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7382
1bc7c5b6 7383@findex default_file_start
914d25dc 7384@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7385Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7386find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7387by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7388quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7389@code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7390lets other target files rely on these variables.
7391@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7392
1bc7c5b6
ZW
7393@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7394If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7395printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7396@option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7397to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7398definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7399assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7400whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7401
7402The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7403verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7404comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7405@end deftypevr
7406
7407@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7408If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7409for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7410@code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7411this to be done. The default is false.
7412@end deftypevr
feca2ed3 7413
b6fd8800 7414@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
a5fe455b
ZW
7415Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7416to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7417@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7418
a5fe455b
ZW
7419@deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7420Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7421special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7422the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7423should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7424need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7425this function.
7426@end deftypefun
feca2ed3 7427
c082f9f3
SB
7428@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7429Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7430to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7431nothing.
7432@end deftypefn
7433
7434@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7435Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7436to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7437nothing.
7438@end deftypefn
7439
6d217c32
JJ
7440@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7441Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7442unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7443here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7444because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7445nothing.
7446@end deftypefn
7447
a2c4f8e0 7448@defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
feca2ed3
JW
7449A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7450assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7451the end of the line.
a2c4f8e0 7452@end defmac
feca2ed3 7453
a2c4f8e0 7454@defmac ASM_APP_ON
feca2ed3
JW
7455A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7456statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7457@code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7458assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7459that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
a2c4f8e0 7460@end defmac
feca2ed3 7461
a2c4f8e0 7462@defmac ASM_APP_OFF
feca2ed3
JW
7463A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7464statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7465@code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7466time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
a2c4f8e0 7467@end defmac
feca2ed3 7468
a2c4f8e0 7469@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7470A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7471which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7472the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7473
7474This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7475for the file format in use is appropriate.
a2c4f8e0 7476@end defmac
feca2ed3 7477
b5f5d41d
AS
7478@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7479Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
edeab219 7480
b5f5d41d
AS
7481 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7482@end deftypefn
7483
a8781821
SB
7484@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7485Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7486@end deftypefn
7487
a2c4f8e0 7488@defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
e9a25f70
JL
7489A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7490@var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
a3a15b4d 7491in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
e9a25f70
JL
7492the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7493of the filename using this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7494@end defmac
e9a25f70 7495
914d25dc 7496@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7c262518
RH
7497Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7498should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
914d25dc
JR
7499of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7500is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7501this section is associated.
7c262518
RH
7502@end deftypefn
7503
f16d3f39
JH
7504@deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7505Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7506Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
ff2ce160 7507functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
f16d3f39
JH
7508at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7509@var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7510(from static destructors).
7511Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7512@end deftypefn
7513
14d11d40
IS
7514@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7515Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7516@end deftypefn
7517
677f3fa8 7518@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7c262518 7519This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
d5fabb58 7520It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
914d25dc 7521@end deftypevr
7c262518 7522
434aeebb 7523@anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
914d25dc 7524@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
434aeebb
RS
7525This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7526section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7527This is true on most ELF targets.
914d25dc 7528@end deftypevr
434aeebb 7529
7c262518
RH
7530@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7531Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7532based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7533declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
6ccde948 7534null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7c262518 7535
224504d2 7536The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7c262518
RH
7537read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7538need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7539set via @code{__attribute__}.
7540@end deftypefn
7541
b6fd8800 7542@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
e0d9d0dd
NC
7543Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7544switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7545enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7546It can take the following values:
7547
7548@table @gcctabopt
7549@item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7550@var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7551
7552@item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7553@var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7554direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7555default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7556command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7557various different individual optimization passes.
7558
7559@item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7560@var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7561ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7562target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7563time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7564warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7565wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7566necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7567perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7568switches.
7569
7570@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7571This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7572
7573@item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7574This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7575@end table
7576
7577The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7578supported in the future.
7579
7580By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7581provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7582it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7583section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7584provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7585hook.
7586@end deftypefn
7587
914d25dc 7588@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
e0d9d0dd
NC
7589This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7590ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7591hook.
914d25dc 7592@end deftypevr
e0d9d0dd 7593
feca2ed3
JW
7594@need 2000
7595@node Data Output
7596@subsection Output of Data
7597
301d03af
RS
7598
7599@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7600@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7601@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7602@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7603@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7604@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7605@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7606@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7607@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7608These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7609of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7610byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7611aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7612@code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7613
7614The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7615followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7616the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7617@end deftypevr
7618
7619@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7620The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7621integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7622in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7623function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7624object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7625split the object into smaller parts.
7626
7627The default implementation of this hook will use the
7628@code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7629when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7630@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 7631
dc2af904
BS
7632@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7633Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7634terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7635@end deftypefn
7636
6cbd8875
AS
7637@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7638A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7639can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7640the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7641@code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7642
7643If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7644so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7645itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7646return @code{true}.
7647@end deftypefn
7648
a2c4f8e0 7649@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
feca2ed3
JW
7650A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7651instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7652bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7653@code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7654
7655If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7656Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7657@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
a2c4f8e0 7658@end defmac
feca2ed3 7659
a2c4f8e0 7660@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
67231816
RH
7661A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7662@var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7663is defined, and is otherwise unused.
a2c4f8e0 7664@end defmac
67231816 7665
a2c4f8e0 7666@defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
861bb6c1 7667You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
df2a54e9 7668expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
861bb6c1 7669pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
a3a15b4d
JL
7670GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7671not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
861bb6c1 7672pool before the function.
a2c4f8e0 7673@end defmac
861bb6c1 7674
a2c4f8e0 7675@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
feca2ed3
JW
7676A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7677constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7678the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7679be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7680is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7681immediately after this call.
7682
7683If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7684not be defined.
a2c4f8e0 7685@end defmac
feca2ed3 7686
a2c4f8e0 7687@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
feca2ed3
JW
7688A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7689constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7690anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7691
7692The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7693assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7694output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7695@samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7696@var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7697alignment.
7698
7699The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7700the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7701responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7702Here is how to do this:
7703
3ab51846 7704@smallexample
4977bab6 7705@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
3ab51846 7706@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
7707
7708When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7709@code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7710entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7711
7712You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
a2c4f8e0 7713@end defmac
feca2ed3 7714
a2c4f8e0 7715@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
861bb6c1
JL
7716A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7717pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7718function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7719obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
a3a15b4d 7720constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
861bb6c1
JL
7721
7722If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7723define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7724@end defmac
861bb6c1 7725
980d8882 7726@defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
feca2ed3 7727Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
980d8882
BS
7728used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7729to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7730a line separator uses multiple characters.
feca2ed3
JW
7731
7732If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7733the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
a2c4f8e0 7734@end defmac
feca2ed3 7735
8ca83838 7736@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
baed53ac 7737@deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
17b53c33
NB
7738These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7739assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7740default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8ca83838 7741@end deftypevr
17b53c33 7742
6ccde948 7743These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
feca2ed3
JW
7744of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7745
a2c4f8e0
ZW
7746@defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7747@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7748@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
dadb213f
BE
7749@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7750@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7751@defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7752These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7753target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7754the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7755@code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7756simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7757@code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7758by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7759it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
776032 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7761on the host machine.
feca2ed3
JW
7762
7763The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7764using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7765machine's memory.
a2c4f8e0 7766@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
7767
7768@node Uninitialized Data
7769@subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7770
7771Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7772outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7773
a2c4f8e0 7774@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7775A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7776@var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7777@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
233215fe
DK
7778is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7779possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7780other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7781backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7782byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7783equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7784the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7785an ordinary undefined external.
feca2ed3
JW
7786
7787Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7788output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7789assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7790
7791This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7792common global variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7793@end defmac
feca2ed3 7794
a2c4f8e0 7795@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7796Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7797separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7798place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7799handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7800as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7801@end defmac
feca2ed3 7802
a2c4f8e0 7803@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7804Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7805variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7806is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7807in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7808@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7809the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7810@end defmac
e9a25f70 7811
07c5f94e 7812@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7813A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7814@var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
07c5f94e
AS
7815@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7816is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
feca2ed3 7817
07c5f94e
AS
7818Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7819@file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
feca2ed3
JW
7820@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7821before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7822the name, and a newline.
7823
07c5f94e 7824There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
434aeebb
RS
7825The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7826switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7827You do not need to do both.
7828
7829Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7830non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7831efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7832not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7833common in order to save space in the object file.
a2c4f8e0 7834@end defmac
feca2ed3 7835
a2c4f8e0 7836@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
feca2ed3
JW
7837A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7838@var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7839@var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7840is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7841
7842Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7843output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7844assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7845
7846This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7847static variables are output.
a2c4f8e0 7848@end defmac
feca2ed3 7849
a2c4f8e0 7850@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
feca2ed3
JW
7851Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7852separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7853place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7854handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7855as the number of bits.
a2c4f8e0 7856@end defmac
feca2ed3 7857
a2c4f8e0 7858@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
e9a25f70
JL
7859Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7860variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8760eaae 7861is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
e9a25f70
JL
7862in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7863@code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7864the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
a2c4f8e0 7865@end defmac
e9a25f70 7866
feca2ed3
JW
7867@node Label Output
7868@subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7869
7870@c prevent bad page break with this line
7871This is about outputting labels.
7872
feca2ed3 7873@findex assemble_name
a2c4f8e0 7874@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
7875A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7876@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7877Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7878output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
4ad5e05d
KG
7879assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7880definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 7881@end defmac
feca2ed3 7882
135a687e
KT
7883@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7884A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7885@var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7886a function.
7887Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7888output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7889assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7890definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7891
7892If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7893usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7894@end defmac
7895
57829bc4
MM
7896@findex assemble_name_raw
7897@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
e374d5c9 7898Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
57829bc4
MM
7899to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7900@code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7901that it is more efficient.
7902@end defmac
7903
a2c4f8e0 7904@defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7905A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7906size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7907default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7908systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7909
7910Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7911of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7912for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7913macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7914define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7915@end defmac
2be2ac70 7916
a2c4f8e0 7917@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
2be2ac70
ZW
7918A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7919@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7920symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7921If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7922provided.
a2c4f8e0 7923@end defmac
2be2ac70 7924
a2c4f8e0 7925@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
2be2ac70
ZW
7926A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
99086d59 7928the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
73774972 7929address.
99086d59
ZW
7930
7931If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7932provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7933@samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7934the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7935not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7936to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
a2c4f8e0 7937@end defmac
2be2ac70 7938
e537ef59
GP
7939@defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7940Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7941@samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7942G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7943@samp{.} is used instead.
7944@end defmac
7945
7946@defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7947Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7948@samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7949have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7950are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7951@end defmac
7952
a2c4f8e0 7953@defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
2be2ac70
ZW
7954A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7955type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7956default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7957systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7958
7959Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7960@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7961custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7962types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7963@end defmac
2be2ac70 7964
a2c4f8e0 7965@defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
2be2ac70
ZW
7966A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7967the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7968default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7969the default is not to define this macro.
7970
7971Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7972@code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7973custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7974types at all, do not define this macro.
a2c4f8e0 7975@end defmac
2be2ac70 7976
a2c4f8e0 7977@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
2be2ac70
ZW
7978A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7979@var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7980symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7981that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7982you should not count on this.
7983
7984If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7985definition of this macro is provided.
a2c4f8e0 7986@end defmac
2be2ac70 7987
a2c4f8e0 7988@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
7989A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7990@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7991function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
7992outputting the label definition (perhaps using
135a687e 7993@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
feca2ed3
JW
7994@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
7995
7996If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
135a687e 7997usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
feca2ed3 7998
2be2ac70
ZW
7999You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8000of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 8001@end defmac
2be2ac70 8002
a2c4f8e0 8003@defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
8004A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8005@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8006which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8007function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8008representing the function.
8009
8010If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8011
2be2ac70
ZW
8012You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8013of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 8014@end defmac
2be2ac70 8015
81ccb752
CT
8016@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8017A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8018@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8019cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8020for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8021@code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8022@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8023
8024If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8025usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8026
8027You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8028of this macro.
8029@end defmac
8030
8031@defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8032A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8033@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8034partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8035cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8036@code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8037
8038If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8039
8040You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8041of this macro.
8042@end defmac
8043
a2c4f8e0 8044@defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
8045A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8046@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8047initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8048label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8049@var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8050
8051If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8052usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8053
2be2ac70
ZW
8054You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8055@code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 8056@end defmac
2be2ac70 8057
ad78130c 8058@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
e4f7c483
AS
8059A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8060for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8061target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8062@code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8063and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8064will be an internal label.
18f3e349 8065
e4f7c483
AS
8066The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8067usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
18f3e349 8068
e4f7c483
AS
8069You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8070@end deftypefn
18f3e349 8071
a2c4f8e0 8072@defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
1cb36a98
RH
8073A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8074@var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8075for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8076
8077If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8078nothing.
a2c4f8e0 8079@end defmac
1cb36a98 8080
a2c4f8e0 8081@defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
feca2ed3
JW
8082A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8083once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8084chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8085initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8086something about the size of the object.
8087
8088If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8089nothing.
8090
2be2ac70
ZW
8091You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8092@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
a2c4f8e0 8093@end defmac
2be2ac70 8094
5eb99654
KG
8095@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8096This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
feca2ed3 8097@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
5eb99654 8098that is, available for reference from other files.
feca2ed3 8099
5eb99654
KG
8100The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8101@code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
b65d23aa 8102@end deftypefn
072cdaed 8103
812b587e
SE
8104@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8105This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8106@var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8107global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8108
8109The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8110@end deftypefn
8111
0d4b5b86
BS
8112@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8113This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8114@var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8115@var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8116assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8117@end deftypefn
8118
a2c4f8e0 8119@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8120A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8121@var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8122that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8123no other definition is available. Use the expression
8124@code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8125itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8126for making that name weak, and a newline.
8127
79c4e63f
AM
8128If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8129support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8130macro.
a2c4f8e0 8131@end defmac
79c4e63f 8132
a2c4f8e0 8133@defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
79c4e63f
AM
8134Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8135@code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8136or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8137should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8138defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8139@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8140to make @var{name} weak.
a2c4f8e0 8141@end defmac
feca2ed3 8142
ff2d10c1
AO
8143@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8144Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8145symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8146declaration of @code{name}.
8147@end defmac
8148
a2c4f8e0 8149@defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
74b90fe2
JDA
8150A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8151supports weak symbols.
feca2ed3
JW
8152
8153If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
79c4e63f 8154definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
74b90fe2
JDA
8155is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8156@end defmac
8157
8158@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8159A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8160
8161If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8162definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8163this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8164flag such as @option{-melf}.
a2c4f8e0 8165@end defmac
feca2ed3 8166
a2c4f8e0 8167@defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
feca2ed3
JW
8168A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8169public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8170be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8171format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8172section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8173requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
a2c4f8e0 8174@end defmac
feca2ed3 8175
a2c4f8e0 8176@defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
feca2ed3
JW
8177A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8178semantics.
8179
8180If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8181definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8182definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
e9a25f70 8183you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
feca2ed3
JW
8184setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8185be emitted as one-only.
a2c4f8e0 8186@end defmac
feca2ed3 8187
914d25dc 8188@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
93638d7a
AM
8189This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8190commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8191hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8192@end deftypefn
8193
0524c91d 8194@defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
4746cf84 8195A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
0524c91d 8196that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
f676971a 8197The default is @code{0}.
0524c91d
MA
8198
8199Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8200if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8201will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8202symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8203thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8204(explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8205with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8206
8207The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8208targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8209restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8210table of contents.
4746cf84
MA
8211@end defmac
8212
a2c4f8e0 8213@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8214A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8215@var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8216symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8217not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8218declaration.
8219
8220This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8221The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
a2c4f8e0 8222@end defmac
feca2ed3 8223
6773a41c
RO
8224@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8225This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
feca2ed3 8226pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
6773a41c
RO
8227library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8228@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8229
914d25dc 8230@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8e3e233b 8231This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
914d25dc
JR
8232directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8233.no_dead_code_strip directive.
8e3e233b
DP
8234@end deftypefn
8235
a2c4f8e0 8236@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3
JW
8237A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8238@var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8239@var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8240is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8241systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
a2c4f8e0 8242@end defmac
feca2ed3 8243
77754180
DK
8244@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8245Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8246@end deftypefn
8247
a2c4f8e0 8248@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
99c8c61c 8249A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
2f0b7af6 8250@code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
99c8c61c
AO
8251will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8252to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
fb49053f 8253encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 8254@end defmac
99c8c61c 8255
a2c4f8e0 8256@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
2f0b7af6 8257A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
4226378a 8258result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
2f0b7af6
GK
8259@code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8260This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8261specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
4226378a
PK
8262when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8263being taken.
a2c4f8e0 8264@end defmac
2f0b7af6 8265
4977bab6
ZW
8266@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8267A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8268name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
feca2ed3
JW
8269
8270It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8271used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8272will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8273
8274It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8275object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8276should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8277beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8278convention your system uses, and follow it.
8279
8a36672b 8280The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
4977bab6 8281@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 8282
a2c4f8e0 8283@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8215347e
JW
8284A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8285label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8286@var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8287may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8288systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8289bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8290bundles.
8291
4977bab6 8292If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8215347e 8293used.
a2c4f8e0 8294@end defmac
8215347e 8295
a2c4f8e0 8296@defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
feca2ed3
JW
8297A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8298is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8299
8300This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
4977bab6 8301produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
feca2ed3
JW
8302with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8303
8304If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8305output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8306@code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8307string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8308to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8309@code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8310you should know what it does on your machine.)
a2c4f8e0 8311@end defmac
feca2ed3 8312
a2c4f8e0 8313@defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
feca2ed3
JW
8314A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8315@code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8316@var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8317added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8318
8319The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8320produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8321@var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8322assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8323macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8324internal static variables in different scopes.
8325
8326Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8327conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8328or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8329between the name and the number will suffice.
8330
4977bab6
ZW
8331If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8332which is correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8333@end defmac
4977bab6 8334
a2c4f8e0 8335@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8336A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8337which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8338
203cb4ef 8339@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8340If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
feca2ed3 8341correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8342@end defmac
810e3c45 8343
a2c4f8e0 8344@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
e4faf1eb 8345A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
3b7a2e58 8346which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
e4faf1eb
NC
8347to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8348be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8349the tree nodes are available.
8350
203cb4ef 8351@findex SET_ASM_OP
aee96fe9 8352If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
956d6950 8353correct for most systems.
a2c4f8e0 8354@end defmac
956d6950 8355
083b6717
JDA
8356@defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8357A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8358(equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8359of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8360current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8361This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8362@samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8363@end defmac
8364
a2c4f8e0 8365@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
810e3c45
JM
8366A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8367which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
3aa8ab7b
L
8368@var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8369an undefined weak symbol.
810e3c45
JM
8370
8371Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
aee96fe9 8372@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
a2c4f8e0 8373@end defmac
810e3c45 8374
a2c4f8e0 8375@defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
feca2ed3 8376Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
2147b154 8377Objective-C methods.
feca2ed3
JW
8378
8379The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8380class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8381the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8382@samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8383
8384These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8385the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8386systems define other ways of computing names.
8387
8388@var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8389buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8390@var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
839150 characters extra.
8392
8393The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8394method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
59d42021 8395@var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
feca2ed3
JW
8396in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8397
8398On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8399macro to provide more human-readable names.
a2c4f8e0 8400@end defmac
28df0b5a 8401
feca2ed3
JW
8402@node Initialization
8403@subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8404@cindex initialization routines
8405@cindex termination routines
8406@cindex constructors, output of
8407@cindex destructors, output of
8408
8409The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8410(also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8411data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8412to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8413@code{main} is called.
8414
8415Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8416@dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8417terminates.
8418
8419To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8420must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8421be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8422system, you need to specify how to do this.
8423
8424There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8425initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8426Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8427
8428@findex __CTOR_LIST__
8429@findex __DTOR_LIST__
8430The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8431initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8432termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8433
8434Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
84350, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8436the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8437pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8438pointer containing zero.
8439
8440Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8441@file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8442time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8443list; destructors in forward order.
8444
8445The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8446formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8447aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8448Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8449object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8450the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8451accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8452Termination functions are handled similarly.
8453
2cc07db4
RH
8454This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8455@code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
f282ffb3 8456support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
2cc07db4
RH
8457constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8458and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
feca2ed3
JW
8459
8460When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8461upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
2cc07db4 8462support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
feca2ed3 8463parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
05739753 8464program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
feca2ed3 8465
3ab51846 8466@smallexample
2cc07db4 8467ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
3ab51846 8468@end smallexample
feca2ed3 8469
2cc07db4
RH
8470The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8471section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8472for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8473files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8474are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8475
8476The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8477compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8478fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8479to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8480of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8481that invokes the routines we need at startup.
feca2ed3
JW
8482
8483To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8484macro properly.
8485
2cc07db4
RH
8486If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8487@code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8488entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8489it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8490after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8491in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
feca2ed3
JW
8492
8493In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8494two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8495and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
2cc07db4 8496@code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
feca2ed3
JW
8497entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8498and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8499code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
2cc07db4 8500the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
feca2ed3
JW
8501placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8502a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
2cc07db4 8503@code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
feca2ed3
JW
8504section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8505the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8506the initialization process.
8507
8508The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8509This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
161d7b59 8510file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
2cc07db4
RH
8511this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8512termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8513an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8514pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8515the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8516initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8517via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8518@code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
feca2ed3
JW
8519
8520@ifinfo
8521The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8522customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8523@end ifinfo
8524
8525@node Macros for Initialization
8526@subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8527
8528Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8529and termination functions:
8530
a2c4f8e0 8531@defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
047c1c92
HPN
8532If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8533operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8534defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8535using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8536macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8537run the initialization functions.
a2c4f8e0 8538@end defmac
feca2ed3 8539
a2c4f8e0 8540@defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
feca2ed3 8541If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
2cc07db4
RH
8542This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8543on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8544be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
a2c4f8e0 8545@end defmac
feca2ed3 8546
a2c4f8e0 8547@defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8548If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8549the following symbol is an initialization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8550@end defmac
feca2ed3 8551
a2c4f8e0 8552@defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
feca2ed3
JW
8553If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8554the following symbol is a finalization routine.
a2c4f8e0 8555@end defmac
feca2ed3 8556
a2c4f8e0 8557@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8558If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8559automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8560should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8561the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
172270b3 8562function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
414e05cf
RE
8563
8564This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
f282ffb3 8565shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
414e05cf 8566exception tables embedded in the code.
a2c4f8e0 8567@end defmac
414e05cf 8568
a2c4f8e0 8569@defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
414e05cf
RE
8570If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8571automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8572should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8573the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
172270b3 8574function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
a2c4f8e0 8575@end defmac
414e05cf 8576
a2c4f8e0 8577@defmac INVOKE__main
feca2ed3
JW
8578If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8579@code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8580where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8581useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
a2c4f8e0 8582@end defmac
feca2ed3 8583
a2c4f8e0 8584@defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
ea4f1fce
JO
8585If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8586compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8587of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8588encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
a2c4f8e0 8589@end defmac
2cc07db4 8590
914d25dc 8591@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
2cc07db4
RH
8592This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8593collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8594It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
914d25dc 8595@end deftypevr
2cc07db4
RH
8596
8597@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8598If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8599the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
ea4f1fce 8600
2cc07db4
RH
8601Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8602no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8603priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8604otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8605
14976c58 8606If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
2cc07db4
RH
8607be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8608target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8609is not defined.
8610@end deftypefn
8611
8612@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8613This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
feca2ed3 8614functions rather than initialization functions.
2cc07db4 8615@end deftypefn
14686fcd 8616
2cc07db4
RH
8617If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8618generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
feca2ed3 8619
2cc07db4
RH
8620If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8621constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8622an object file for constructor functions to be called.
14686fcd 8623
4a023207 8624On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
2cc07db4 8625@command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
feca2ed3 8626
a2c4f8e0 8627@defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
feca2ed3 8628Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
2cc07db4 8629object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
feca2ed3 8630object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
feca2ed3 8631
4a023207 8632This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
2cc07db4 8633part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
a2c4f8e0 8634@end defmac
feca2ed3 8635
a2c4f8e0 8636@defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
feca2ed3 8637Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
2cc07db4
RH
8638to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8639@command{nm}.
3e794bfe
RO
8640@end defmac
8641
8642@defmac NM_FLAGS
8643@command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8644constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8645passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
2b0d3573 8646are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
3e794bfe
RO
8647produces.
8648@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8649
8650If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8651dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8652these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8653termination functions in shared libraries:
8654
a2c4f8e0 8655@defmac LDD_SUFFIX
2cc07db4 8656Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
3e794bfe 8657which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
a2c4f8e0 8658@end defmac
feca2ed3 8659
a2c4f8e0 8660@defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
feca2ed3 8661Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
aee96fe9 8662of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
feca2ed3
JW
8663of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8664from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
aee96fe9
JM
8665code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8666line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
a2c4f8e0 8667@end defmac
feca2ed3 8668
881466d8
JDA
8669@defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8670Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8671library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8672strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8673constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8674that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8675@end defmac
8676
feca2ed3
JW
8677@node Instruction Output
8678@subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8679
8680@c prevent bad page break with this line
8681This describes assembler instruction output.
8682
a2c4f8e0 8683@defmac REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8684A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8685registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8686register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
a2c4f8e0 8687@end defmac
feca2ed3 8688
a2c4f8e0 8689@defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
feca2ed3
JW
8690If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8691and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8692registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8693to registers using alternate names.
a2c4f8e0 8694@end defmac
feca2ed3 8695
0c6d290e
RE
8696@defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8697If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8698name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8699machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8700names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8701declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8702@code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8703register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8704
8705This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8706@code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8707register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8708VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8709``s0'' and ``s1''.
8710@end defmac
8711
a2c4f8e0 8712@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
feca2ed3
JW
8713Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8714requires different names for the machine instructions.
8715
8716The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8717assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8718macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8719points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8720written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8721opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8722increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8723so that it will not be output twice.
8724
8725In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8726name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8727that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8728care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8729@var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8730
37bef197 8731@findex recog_data.operand
feca2ed3 8732If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
37bef197 8733elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
feca2ed3
JW
8734
8735If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8736in the usual way.
a2c4f8e0 8737@end defmac
feca2ed3 8738
a2c4f8e0 8739@defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
feca2ed3
JW
8740If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8741assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8742they will be output differently.
8743
8744Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8745extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8746elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8747The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8748template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8749by changing the contents of the vector.
8750
8751This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8752file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8753can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8754as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8755syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8756writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8757
8758If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
a2c4f8e0 8759@end defmac
feca2ed3 8760
ac44248e 8761@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
1afc5373
CF
8762If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8763output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8764if necessary.
8765
8766Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8767extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8768elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8769The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8770template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8771by checking the contents of the vector.
8772@end deftypefn
8773
a2c4f8e0 8774@defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8775A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8776assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8777RTL expression.
8778
8779@var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8780of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8781printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8782the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8783operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8784@var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8785@var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8786
8787@findex reg_names
8788If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8789The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8790@code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8791@code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8792
8793When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8794(a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8795with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8796@var{code}.
a2c4f8e0 8797@end defmac
feca2ed3 8798
a2c4f8e0 8799@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
feca2ed3
JW
8800A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8801punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8802@code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8803punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8804in this way.
a2c4f8e0 8805@end defmac
feca2ed3 8806
a2c4f8e0 8807@defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
8808A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8809assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8810whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8811
fb49053f 8812@cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
feca2ed3 8813On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
fb49053f
RH
8814section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8815@code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8816@code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8817Format}.
8818@end defmac
feca2ed3 8819
feca2ed3 8820@findex dbr_sequence_length
a2c4f8e0 8821@defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
feca2ed3
JW
8822A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8823been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8824determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8825currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8826or whatever.
8827
8828Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8829reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
e979f9e8 8830explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
a2c4f8e0 8831@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8832
8833@findex final_sequence
8834Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
e979f9e8
JM
8835prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8836(i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
feca2ed3
JW
8837found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8838processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8839being output.
8840
feca2ed3 8841@findex asm_fprintf
a2c4f8e0
ZW
8842@defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8843@defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8844@defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8845@defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
feca2ed3
JW
8846If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8847@samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8848@file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8849support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8850files can define these macros differently.
a2c4f8e0 8851@end defmac
feca2ed3 8852
a2c4f8e0 8853@defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
3b7a2e58 8854If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
fe0503ea
NC
8855statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8856the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8857printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
4bd0bee9 8858statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
fe0503ea
NC
8859generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8860specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8861The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8862string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8863upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
a2c4f8e0 8864@end defmac
fe0503ea 8865
a2c4f8e0 8866@defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
feca2ed3
JW
8867If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8868different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8869numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8870first variant.
8871
8872If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
c237e94a 8873@smallexample
f282ffb3 8874@samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
c237e94a
ZW
8875@end smallexample
8876@noindent
8877in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8878first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8879@samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8880@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8881within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8882alternatives within the braces than the value of
382522cb
MK
8883@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8884to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8885@samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
feca2ed3
JW
8886
8887If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8888@samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8889operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8890
8891Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8892@code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
e5e809f4 8893the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
feca2ed3
JW
8894@code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8895if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8896opcodes or operand order.
a2c4f8e0 8897@end defmac
feca2ed3 8898
a2c4f8e0 8899@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8900A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8901which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8902The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8903profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8904@end defmac
feca2ed3 8905
a2c4f8e0 8906@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
feca2ed3
JW
8907A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8908which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8909The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8910profiling.
a2c4f8e0 8911@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
8912
8913@node Dispatch Tables
8914@subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8915
8916@c prevent bad page break with this line
8917This concerns dispatch tables.
8918
feca2ed3 8919@cindex dispatch table
a2c4f8e0 8920@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
feca2ed3
JW
8921A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8922pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8923@var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8924definitions of these labels are output using
4977bab6 8925@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
feca2ed3
JW
8926way here. For example,
8927
3ab51846 8928@smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8929fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8930 @var{value}, @var{rel})
3ab51846 8931@end smallexample
feca2ed3
JW
8932
8933You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
f0523f02 8934dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
161d7b59 8935will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
aee96fe9 8936@var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
33f7f353 8937mode and flags can be read.
a2c4f8e0 8938@end defmac
feca2ed3 8939
a2c4f8e0 8940@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
feca2ed3
JW
8941This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8942in a dispatch table are absolute.
8943
8944The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8945@var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8946a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
4977bab6 8947definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
feca2ed3
JW
8948For example,
8949
3ab51846 8950@smallexample
feca2ed3 8951fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
3ab51846 8952@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 8953@end defmac
feca2ed3 8954
a2c4f8e0 8955@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8956Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8957specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
4977bab6 8958@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
da5c6bde 8959jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
feca2ed3
JW
8960@code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8961
8962This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8963for the table.
8964
8965If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
4977bab6 8966@code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
a2c4f8e0 8967@end defmac
feca2ed3 8968
a2c4f8e0 8969@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
feca2ed3
JW
8970Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8971jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8972after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8973the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8974@var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8975of the preceding label.
8976
8977If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8978the jump-table.
a2c4f8e0 8979@end defmac
feca2ed3 8980
914d25dc 8981@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8a36672b 8982This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
4746cf84
MA
8983should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8984should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8985function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
eeab4d81
MS
8986The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8987exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8a36672b 8988true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
4746cf84
MA
8989
8990The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8991@end deftypefn
8992
914d25dc 8993@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
083cad55
EC
8994This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
8995It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
8996to be broken up according to function.
8997
8998The default is that no label is emitted.
8999@end deftypefn
9000
a68b5e52
RH
9001@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9002If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9003@end deftypefn
9004
ac44248e 9005@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
914d25dc 9006This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
f0a0390e
RH
9007given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9008returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
951120ea
PB
9009@end deftypefn
9010
3bc6b3e6
RH
9011@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9012True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9013@end deftypevr
9014
02f52e19 9015@node Exception Region Output
feca2ed3
JW
9016@subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9017
9018@c prevent bad page break with this line
9019
9020This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9021region.
9022
a2c4f8e0 9023@defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
7c262518
RH
9024If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9025exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9026provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9027@file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
0021b564
JM
9028
9029You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9030unwind information and the default definition does not work.
a2c4f8e0 9031@end defmac
0021b564 9032
04218b35
AD
9033@defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9034If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9035specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9036labels and generate code to register the frames.
02c9b1ca 9037
04218b35
AD
9038This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9039place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9040or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9041be marked as not to be collected.
a2c4f8e0 9042@end defmac
02c9b1ca 9043
1a35e62d
MM
9044@defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9045Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9046information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9047runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9048and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9049@end defmac
9050
a2c4f8e0 9051@defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
aee96fe9 9052An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
feca2ed3 9053that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
a2c4f8e0 9054@end defmac
0021b564 9055
a2c4f8e0 9056@defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
0021b564
JM
9057Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9058information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9059Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
01a07a64
SB
9060@code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9061GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
f0a0390e 9062@end defmac
0021b564 9063
677f3fa8 9064@deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
f0a0390e
RH
9065This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9066by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9067should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9068@code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9069should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9070information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
0021b564 9071
f0a0390e
RH
9072A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9073This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9074default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
0021b564 9075
f0a0390e 9076Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
d5fabb58
JM
9077not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9078@var{opts}. In particular, the
f0a0390e
RH
9079setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9080macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9081depending on this setting.
9082
9083The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9084@option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
d5fabb58
JM
9085@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9086@code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9087must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
f0a0390e 9088@end deftypefn
951120ea 9089
677f3fa8 9090@deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
617a1b71 9091This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
d5fabb58
JM
9092tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9093command-line option processing.
9e3be889 9094@end deftypevr
617a1b71 9095
4f6c2131
EB
9096@defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9097Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9098should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9099instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
c14aea87
RO
9100@end defmac
9101
39ce30d8
SB
9102@defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9103This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9104defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9105for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9106is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9107The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9108@end defmac
9109
a2c4f8e0 9110@defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
27c35f4b
HPN
9111This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9112function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9113@code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
62f9f30b 9114alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
27c35f4b
HPN
9115minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9116the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
a2c4f8e0 9117@end defmac
feca2ed3 9118
9e3be889 9119@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
7606e68f
SS
9120Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9121end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9122Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9123true otherwise.
9e3be889 9124@end deftypevr
7606e68f 9125
96714395
AH
9126@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9127Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9128represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9129register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9130locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9131register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9132If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9133@end deftypefn
9134
ef4bddc2 9135@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
ff050c66
MF
9136Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9137corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9138used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9139clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9140@end deftypefn
9141
37ea0b7e
JM
9142@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9143If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9144multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9145sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9146It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9147filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9148@var{address} is the address of the table.
9149@end deftypefn
9150
617a1b71
PB
9151@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9152This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9153the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9154if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9155reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9156@end deftypefn
9157
914d25dc
JR
9158@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9159This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
617a1b71
PB
9160based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9161the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9162running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
914d25dc 9163@end deftypevr
617a1b71 9164
feca2ed3
JW
9165@node Alignment Output
9166@subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9167
9168@c prevent bad page break with this line
9169This describes commands for alignment.
9170
a2c4f8e0 9171@defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
247a370b 9172The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
f710504c 9173a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
25e22dc0
JH
9174
9175This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9176to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9177define the macro.
efa3896a 9178
3446405d
JH
9179Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9180to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
74f7912a 9181@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
247a370b 9182selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9183@end defmac
247a370b 9184
9158a0d8 9185@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36
DD
9186The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9187@code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9188@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9189@end deftypefn
9190
a2c4f8e0 9191@defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
247a370b
JH
9192The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9193a @code{BARRIER}.
9194
9195This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9196to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9197define the macro.
a2c4f8e0 9198@end defmac
3446405d 9199
9158a0d8 9200@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36 9201The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
efa3896a
GK
9202@code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9203@code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
ad0c4c36 9204@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9205
a2c4f8e0 9206@defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
58a51369
SB
9207The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9208a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
feca2ed3
JW
9209
9210This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9211to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9212define the macro.
9213
efa3896a 9214Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9215to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
74f7912a 9216@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9217selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9218@end defmac
efa3896a 9219
9158a0d8 9220@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36
DD
9221The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9222@var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9223defined.
9224@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9225
a2c4f8e0 9226@defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
fc470718 9227The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
aee96fe9 9228If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
fc470718
R
9229the maximum of the specified values is used.
9230
efa3896a 9231Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
aee96fe9 9232to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
74f7912a 9233@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
aee96fe9 9234selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
a2c4f8e0 9235@end defmac
efa3896a 9236
9158a0d8 9237@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
ad0c4c36
DD
9238The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9239to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9240is defined.
9241@end deftypefn
efa3896a 9242
a2c4f8e0 9243@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
feca2ed3
JW
9244A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9245instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9246Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
606e938d 9247expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
a2c4f8e0 9248@end defmac
feca2ed3 9249
a2c4f8e0 9250@defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
feca2ed3 9251Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
556e0f21 9252text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
feca2ed3
JW
9253This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9254produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9255section.
a2c4f8e0 9256@end defmac
feca2ed3 9257
a2c4f8e0 9258@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
feca2ed3
JW
9259A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9260command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9261@var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9262@end defmac
26f63a77 9263
a2c4f8e0 9264@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
8e16ab99
SF
9265Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9266for padding, if necessary.
a2c4f8e0 9267@end defmac
8e16ab99 9268
a2c4f8e0 9269@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
26f63a77
JL
9270A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9271command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9272@var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9273satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9274a C expression of type @code{int}.
a2c4f8e0 9275@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9276
9277@need 3000
9278@node Debugging Info
9279@section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9280
9281@c prevent bad page break with this line
9282This describes how to specify debugging information.
9283
9284@menu
9285* All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9286* DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9287* DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9288* File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9289* SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
5f98259a 9290* VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
feca2ed3
JW
9291@end menu
9292
9293@node All Debuggers
9294@subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9295
9296@c prevent bad page break with this line
9297These macros affect all debugging formats.
9298
a2c4f8e0 9299@defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
feca2ed3 9300A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
4617e3b5
KG
9301register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9302of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9303some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9304versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9305compiler and another for DBX@.
feca2ed3 9306
a3a15b4d 9307If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
feca2ed3
JW
9308used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9309consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9310Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9311expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9312
9313If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9314does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9315redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
a2c4f8e0 9316@end defmac
feca2ed3 9317
a2c4f8e0 9318@defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9319A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9320variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9321computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9322gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9323that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9324for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
630d3d5a 9325@option{-g} options is used.
a2c4f8e0 9326@end defmac
feca2ed3 9327
a2c4f8e0 9328@defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
feca2ed3
JW
9329A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9330having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9331@var{offset}.
a2c4f8e0 9332@end defmac
feca2ed3 9333
a2c4f8e0 9334@defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
a3a15b4d 9335A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
630d3d5a 9336produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
a3a15b4d 9337this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
e5e809f4 9338debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
5f98259a
RK
9339@code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9340@code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
feca2ed3 9341
630d3d5a 9342When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
e5e809f4 9343value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
16201823 9344exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
e5e809f4 9345value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
a3a15b4d 9346defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
deabc777 9347
feca2ed3 9348The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
630d3d5a 9349user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
def66b10 9350@option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
a2c4f8e0 9351@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9352
9353@node DBX Options
9354@subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9355
9356@c prevent bad page break with this line
9357These are specific options for DBX output.
9358
a2c4f8e0 9359@defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9360Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
630d3d5a 9361in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9362@end defmac
feca2ed3 9363
a2c4f8e0 9364@defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9365Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
630d3d5a 9366in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
a2c4f8e0 9367@end defmac
feca2ed3 9368
a2c4f8e0 9369@defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
a3a15b4d 9370Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
feca2ed3
JW
9371GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9372debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9373macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9374if there is any occasion to.
a2c4f8e0 9375@end defmac
feca2ed3 9376
a2c4f8e0 9377@defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
feca2ed3
JW
9378Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9379in the text section.
a2c4f8e0 9380@end defmac
feca2ed3 9381
a2c4f8e0 9382@defmac ASM_STABS_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9383A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9384use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9385If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9386applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9387@end defmac
feca2ed3 9388
a2c4f8e0 9389@defmac ASM_STABD_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9390A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9391use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9392value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9393@code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9394information format.
a2c4f8e0 9395@end defmac
feca2ed3 9396
a2c4f8e0 9397@defmac ASM_STABN_OP
047c1c92
HPN
9398A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9399use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9400name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9401macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
a2c4f8e0 9402@end defmac
feca2ed3 9403
a2c4f8e0 9404@defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
feca2ed3
JW
9405Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9406@samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9407describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9408On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
a2c4f8e0 9409@end defmac
feca2ed3 9410
a2c4f8e0 9411@defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
feca2ed3
JW
9412A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9413continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9414exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9415operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9416must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9417with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9418defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
a2c4f8e0 9419@end defmac
feca2ed3 9420
a2c4f8e0 9421@defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
feca2ed3
JW
9422Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9423the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9424a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9425constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9426if backslash is correct for your system.
a2c4f8e0 9427@end defmac
feca2ed3 9428
a2c4f8e0 9429@defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
feca2ed3
JW
9430Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9431outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9432variable.
a2c4f8e0 9433@end defmac
feca2ed3 9434
a2c4f8e0 9435@defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9436The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9437for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9438@end defmac
feca2ed3 9439
a2c4f8e0 9440@defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9441The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9442for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9443provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
a2c4f8e0 9444@end defmac
feca2ed3 9445
a2c4f8e0 9446@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
feca2ed3
JW
9447The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9448for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9449``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
a2c4f8e0 9450@end defmac
feca2ed3 9451
a2c4f8e0 9452@defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
feca2ed3
JW
9453The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9454passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9455do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
a2c4f8e0 9456@end defmac
feca2ed3 9457
a2c4f8e0 9458@defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
feca2ed3
JW
9459Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9460arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9461in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9462code.
a2c4f8e0 9463@end defmac
feca2ed3 9464
a2c4f8e0 9465@defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
3e487b21
ZW
9466Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9467the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9468relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9469an absolute address.
9470@end defmac
9471
9472@defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9473Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9474the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9475start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
a2c4f8e0 9476@end defmac
feca2ed3 9477
a2c4f8e0 9478@defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
f0523f02 9479Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
feca2ed3 9480@code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
f0523f02
JM
9481macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9482number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
feca2ed3
JW
9483generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9484number for a type number.
a2c4f8e0 9485@end defmac
feca2ed3
JW
9486
9487@node DBX Hooks
9488@subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9489
9490@c prevent bad page break with this line
9491These are hooks for DBX format.
9492
3e487b21
ZW
9493@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9494A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9495number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
8a36672b 9496@var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
3e487b21
ZW
9497invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9498unique labels in the assembly output.
9499
9500This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9501if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9502@end defmac
9503
a2c4f8e0 9504@defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
feca2ed3 9505Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
c771326b 9506@code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
feca2ed3
JW
9507On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9508disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
a2c4f8e0 9509@end defmac
feca2ed3 9510
5d865dac
EB
9511@defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9512Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9513extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9514feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9515@end defmac
9516
feca2ed3
JW
9517@node File Names and DBX
9518@subsection File Names in DBX Format
9519
9520@c prevent bad page break with this line
9521This describes file names in DBX format.
9522
a2c4f8e0 9523@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9524A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
93a27b7b 9525@var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
feca2ed3
JW
9526file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9527This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9528
9529This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9530for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
93a27b7b
ZW
9531
9532It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9533text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9534to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9535@var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
a2c4f8e0 9536@end defmac
feca2ed3 9537
93a27b7b
ZW
9538@defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9539Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9540of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9541the beginning of the file.
9542@end defmac
feca2ed3 9543
93a27b7b
ZW
9544@defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9545Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9546that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9547an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9548@samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
a2c4f8e0 9549@end defmac
feca2ed3 9550
a2c4f8e0 9551@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
feca2ed3 9552A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
93a27b7b
ZW
9553compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9554written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
feca2ed3
JW
9555
9556If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9557of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
a2c4f8e0 9558@end defmac
feca2ed3 9559
3e487b21
ZW
9560@defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9561Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9562@code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
e4ae5e77 9563the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
3e487b21
ZW
9564whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9565@end defmac
9566
feca2ed3
JW
9567@need 2000
9568@node SDB and DWARF
9569@subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9570
9571@c prevent bad page break with this line
9572Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9573
a2c4f8e0 9574@defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
53943148 9575Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
630d3d5a 9576for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
a2c4f8e0 9577@end defmac
feca2ed3 9578
a2c4f8e0 9579@defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
a3a15b4d 9580Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
630d3d5a 9581debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
f3ff3f4a 9582
b6fd8800 9583@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
a1c496cb
EC
9584Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9585be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9586value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9587@end deftypefn
9588
861bb6c1
JL
9589To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9590define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9591@code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9592prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
08c148a8 9593as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
a2c4f8e0 9594@end defmac
861bb6c1 9595
a2c4f8e0 9596@defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
a3a15b4d 9597Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
f0a0390e
RH
9598Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9599(@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9600exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9601how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
a2c4f8e0 9602@end defmac
9ec36da5 9603
f0a0390e
RH
9604@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9605This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9606unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9607@code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9608return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9609
9610A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9611is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9612
9613A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9614This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9615@end deftypefn
9616
a2c4f8e0 9617@defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
b2244e22
JW
9618Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9619line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9620tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
a2c4f8e0 9621@end defmac
b2244e22 9622
9730bc27
TT
9623@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9624True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9625@end deftypevr
9626
638c962f
JH
9627@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9628True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9629@end deftypevr
9630
2ba42841 9631@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
a50fa76a
BS
9632True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9633This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
2ba42841
AO
9634@end deftypevr
9635
9636@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
a50fa76a
BS
9637True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9638This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9639@end deftypevr
9640
9641@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9642True if register allocation and the passes
9643following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9644targets.
2ba42841
AO
9645@end deftypevr
9646
a2c4f8e0 9647@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
7606e68f 9648A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
192d0f89 9649@var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9650@end defmac
7606e68f 9651
67ad2ae7
DR
9652@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9653A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9654between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9655slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9656@end defmac
9657
192d0f89 9658@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
7606e68f 9659A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
192d0f89
GK
9660section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9661given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
a2c4f8e0 9662@end defmac
7606e68f 9663
a2c4f8e0 9664@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
7606e68f 9665A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
192d0f89 9666reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
a2c4f8e0 9667@end defmac
7606e68f 9668
04218b35
AD
9669@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9670A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9671given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9672@end defmac
9673
7e49a4b3
OH
9674@defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9675A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9676the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9677is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9678is referenced by a function.
9679@end defmac
9680
914d25dc 9681@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
fdbe66f2
EB
9682If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9683reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9684@end deftypefn
9685
a2c4f8e0 9686@defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
feca2ed3
JW
9687Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9688SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9689macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9690not define them yourself.
a2c4f8e0 9691@end defmac
feca2ed3 9692
a2c4f8e0 9693@defmac SDB_DELIM
feca2ed3
JW
9694Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9695SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9696delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9697a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9698required.
a2c4f8e0 9699@end defmac
feca2ed3 9700
a2c4f8e0 9701@defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9702Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9703union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9704allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9705it.
a2c4f8e0 9706@end defmac
feca2ed3 9707
a2c4f8e0 9708@defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
feca2ed3
JW
9709Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9710enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9711assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
a2c4f8e0 9712@end defmac
feca2ed3 9713
3e487b21
ZW
9714@defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9715A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9716number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9717@var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9718@end defmac
9719
5f98259a
RK
9720@need 2000
9721@node VMS Debug
9722@subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9723
9724@c prevent bad page break with this line
9725Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9726
a2c4f8e0 9727@defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
5f98259a
RK
9728Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9729in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9730is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9731@option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
fac0f722 9732behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
74f7912a 9733@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
a2c4f8e0 9734@end defmac
5f98259a 9735
b216cd4a 9736@node Floating Point
feca2ed3
JW
9737@section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9738@cindex cross compilation and floating point
9739@cindex floating point and cross compilation
9740
b216cd4a 9741While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
feca2ed3
JW
9742there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9743means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9744in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9745doing the compilation.
9746
feca2ed3 9747Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
b216cd4a
ZW
9748range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9749the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9750safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9751the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9752emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9753target floating point formats are identical.
9754
9755The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9756use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
ba31d94e
ZW
9757floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9758their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
feca2ed3 9759
b216cd4a
ZW
9760@defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9761The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9762machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9763array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9764quantity.
9765@end defmac
9766
b216cd4a
ZW
9767@deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9768Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9769@end deftypefn
9770
9771@deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9772Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9773@var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9774@end deftypefn
9775
ef4bddc2 9776@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
b216cd4a
ZW
9777Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9778representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9779decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9780defined by the C language for both.
9781@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 9782
15e5ad76 9783@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
ce3649d2 9784Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
15e5ad76
ZW
9785@end deftypefn
9786
b216cd4a
ZW
9787@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9788Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9789@end deftypefn
9790
9791@deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9792Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9793@end deftypefn
9794
b216cd4a
ZW
9795@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9796Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9797@end deftypefn
9798
15e5ad76
ZW
9799@deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9800Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9801@end deftypefn
9802
9f09b1f2
R
9803@node Mode Switching
9804@section Mode Switching Instructions
9805@cindex mode switching
9806The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9807
a2c4f8e0 9808@defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9f09b1f2
R
9809Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9810switching in an optimizing compilation.
9811
9812For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9813floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9814the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9815operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9816purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
e979f9e8 9817be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
18dbd950 9818or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9f09b1f2
R
9819
9820You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9821which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
14976c58 9822return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9f09b1f2 9823If you define this macro, you also have to define
06b90602
CB
9824@code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9825@code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9826@code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
73774972 9827are optional.
a2c4f8e0 9828@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9829
a2c4f8e0 9830@defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9f09b1f2
R
9831If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9832initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9833N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9834of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
78466c0e
JM
9835The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9836zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9f09b1f2
R
9837entity in question.
9838In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
630d3d5a 9839represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9f09b1f2 9840switch is needed / supplied.
a2c4f8e0 9841@end defmac
9f09b1f2 9842
cbb1e3d9
CB
9843@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
9844Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
06b90602 9845@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9846
ac44248e 9847@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
cbb1e3d9 9848@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
06b90602 9849@end deftypefn
73774972 9850
ac44248e 9851@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
06b90602
CB
9852@var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
9853@end deftypefn
73774972 9854
06b90602
CB
9855@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
9856If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9857@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9858
06b90602
CB
9859@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
9860If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9861@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9862
06b90602
CB
9863@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
9864This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9865@end deftypefn
9f09b1f2 9866
91d231cb
JM
9867@node Target Attributes
9868@section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9869@cindex target attributes
9870@cindex machine attributes
9871@cindex attributes, target-specific
9872
9873Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9874These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9875be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9876
9877@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9878If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
15ab4e1e 9879attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
91d231cb
JM
9880specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9881entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9882take.
9883@end deftypevr
9884
564a129d
JM
9885@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9886If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9887machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9888given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9889subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9890false for all machine-specific attributes.
9891@end deftypefn
9892
b6fd8800 9893@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
91d231cb
JM
9894If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9895@var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9896and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9897generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9898supposed always to be compatible.
9899@end deftypefn
9900
9901@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9902If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
914d25dc 9903the newly defined @var{type}.
91d231cb
JM
9904@end deftypefn
9905
9906@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9907Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9908handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9909@code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9910that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9911function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9912merging.
9913@end deftypefn
9914
9915@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9916Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9917handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9918@code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9919@var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9920when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9921attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9922call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9923
9924@findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
b2ca3702
MM
9925If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9926for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9927@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9928will then define a function called
9929@code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9930the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9931add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9932to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9933@samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9934@file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
91d231cb
JM
9935@end deftypefn
9936
b6fd8800 9937@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 9938@var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
43d9ad1d
DS
9939@end deftypefn
9940
63c5b495 9941@defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
1a141fe1 9942Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
63c5b495
MM
9943@code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9944default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9945@code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9946of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9947on this implementation detail.
9948@end defmac
9949
91d231cb
JM
9950@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9951Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9952when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9953wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9954the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9955created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9956for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9957shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9958the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9959attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9960needed.
9961@end deftypefn
9962
65a324b4 9963@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
91d231cb 9964@cindex inlining
5bd40ade 9965This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
91d231cb
JM
9966into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9967attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9968target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9969@end deftypefn
9970
914d25dc 9971@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9972This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9973allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9974These function-specific options may differ
9975from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
ab442df7
MM
9976@code{true} if the options are valid.
9977
7aa7f2e3
SL
9978The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9979the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9980@code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9981@end deftypefn
9982
bf7b5747 9983@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9984This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9985in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
bf7b5747 9986options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9987@xref{Option file format}.
9988@end deftypefn
9989
bf7b5747 9990@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
7aa7f2e3
SL
9991This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
9992information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
bf7b5747 9993function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
ab442df7
MM
9994@end deftypefn
9995
59913123
JJ
9996@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9997This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
9998@code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
9999LTO bytecode.
10000@end deftypefn
10001
d2143a2f 10002@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
7aa7f2e3
SL
10003This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10004information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10005function-specific options.
ab442df7
MM
10006@end deftypefn
10007
56cb42ea 10008@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
7aa7f2e3
SL
10009This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10010sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10011input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
56cb42ea 10012@code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
ab442df7
MM
10013@end deftypefn
10014
74f7912a
JR
10015@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10016Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10017a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10018@code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10019once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10020
10021Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
fac0f722 10022@option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
74f7912a
JR
10023
10024If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10025changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10026@code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10027@end deftypefn
10028
3649b9b7
ST
10029@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10030This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10031versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10032versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10033different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10034different target machines.
10035@end deftypefn
10036
ab442df7
MM
10037@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10038This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10039cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10040default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10041specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10042@end deftypefn
10043
63b0cb04
CB
10044@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10045This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10046@end deftypefn
10047
feb60f03
NS
10048@node Emulated TLS
10049@section Emulating TLS
10050@cindex Emulated TLS
10051
10052For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10053specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10054used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10055configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
a640c13b 10056the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
feb60f03
NS
10057layer.
10058
10059The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10060object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10061which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10062address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10063
10064@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10065Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10066object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10067emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10068@end deftypevr
10069
10070@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10071Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10072program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10073initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10074have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10075registration function to be used.
10076@end deftypevr
10077
10078@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10079Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10080be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10081any section.
10082@end deftypevr
10083
10084@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10085Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10086placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10087section.
10088@end deftypevr
10089
10090@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10091Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10092The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10093@end deftypevr
10094
10095@deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10096Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10097default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10098@end deftypevr
10099
10100@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10101Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10102object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10103@var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10104@code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10105for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10106@end deftypefn
10107
10108@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10109Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10110TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10111is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10112initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10113@end deftypefn
10114
b6fd8800 10115@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
feb60f03
NS
10116Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10117fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10118single objects. The default is false.
10119@end deftypevr
10120
b6fd8800 10121@deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
feb60f03
NS
10122Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10123may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10124@end deftypevr
10125
d604bca3
MH
10126@node MIPS Coprocessors
10127@section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10128@cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10129
10130The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
2dd76960 10131coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
d604bca3
MH
10132accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10133and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10134
10135@smallexample
10136 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10137 unsigned int d;
10138
10139 d = cp0count + 3;
10140@end smallexample
10141
10142(``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10143names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10144overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10145
10146Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10147be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10148later in the function.
10149
10150Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
8a36672b 10151the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
d604bca3
MH
10152floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10153
7bb1ad93
GK
10154@node PCH Target
10155@section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10156@cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10157
0678ade0 10158@deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
914d25dc
JR
10159This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10160@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
0678ade0 10161@samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
7bb1ad93
GK
10162@end deftypefn
10163
b6fd8800 10164@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
8d932be3
RS
10165This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10166compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10167if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10168be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10169
10170@var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10171when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10172It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10173compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10174
10175The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10176suitable for most targets.
10177@end deftypefn
10178
b6fd8800 10179@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
8d932be3
RS
10180If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10181@code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10182of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10183@code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10184value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
7bb1ad93
GK
10185@end deftypefn
10186
e32ea2d1
RS
10187@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10188Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10189garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10190it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10191to do anything here.
10192@end deftypefn
10193
4185ae53
PB
10194@node C++ ABI
10195@section C++ ABI parameters
10196@cindex parameters, c++ abi
10197
10198@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10199Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10200These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10201default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10202@end deftypefn
10203
10204@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
f676971a 10205This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
914d25dc
JR
10206@code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10207@code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
4185ae53
PB
10208@end deftypefn
10209
46e995e0
PB
10210@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10211This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10212whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10213known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10214@code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
8a36672b 10215IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
46e995e0
PB
10216@end deftypefn
10217
10218@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10219This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10220array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10221@end deftypefn
10222
38f8b050 10223@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
d59c7b4b
NC
10224If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10225class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
78466c0e 10226will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
d59c7b4b
NC
10227to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10228modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10229backend's targeted operating system.
10230@end deftypefn
10231
44d10c10
PB
10232@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10233This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10234the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10235@code{false}.
10236@end deftypefn
10237
af287697
MM
10238@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10239This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10240which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10241table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10242Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10243the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10244some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10245method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10246@end deftypefn
10247
1e731102 10248@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
38f8b050 10249@var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
1e731102
MM
10250@end deftypefn
10251
10252@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10253This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10254similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10255external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10256classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10257unit will not be COMDAT.
505970fc
MM
10258@end deftypefn
10259
157600d0
GK
10260@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10261This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10262the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10263be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10264@end deftypefn
10265
9f62c3e3
PB
10266@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10267This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10268should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10269is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10270@end deftypefn
10271
97388150
DS
10272@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10273This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10274in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10275destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10276shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10277unloaded. The default is to return false.
10278@end deftypefn
10279
43d9ad1d 10280@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
38f8b050 10281@var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
43d9ad1d
DS
10282@end deftypefn
10283
5b880ea6
RO
10284@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10285Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10286@end deftypefn
10287
09e881c9
BE
10288@node Named Address Spaces
10289@section Adding support for named address spaces
10290@cindex named address spaces
10291
10292The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10293standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10294support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10295processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10296GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10297address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10298spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10299@code{const} type attributes.
10300
02a9370c 10301Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
09e881c9
BE
10302pointers to the generic address space.
10303
10304For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10305to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10306processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10307issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10308local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10309address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10310@option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10311always 32 bits).
10312
10313Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10314range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10315address space.
10316
3ef0694c
UW
10317To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10318the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10319the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10320named address space #1:
36c5e70a
BE
10321@smallexample
10322#define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
3ef0694c 10323c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
36c5e70a 10324@end smallexample
36c5e70a 10325
ef4bddc2 10326@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
d4ebfa65
BE
10327Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10328@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
0a798c16 10329The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
d4ebfa65
BE
10330@end deftypefn
10331
ef4bddc2 10332@deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
d4ebfa65
BE
10333Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10334@var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
0a798c16 10335The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
d4ebfa65
BE
10336@end deftypefn
10337
ef4bddc2 10338@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
d4ebfa65
BE
10339Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10340with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10341hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10342except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10343version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10344@code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10345target hooks for the given address space.
10346@end deftypefn
10347
ef4bddc2 10348@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10349Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10350@var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10351parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10352finished. This target hook is the same as the
10353@code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10354explicit named address space support.
10355@end deftypefn
10356
ef4bddc2 10357@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
09e881c9
BE
10358Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10359with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10360hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10361except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10362@end deftypefn
10363
b5bcaa4a 10364@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
09e881c9
BE
10365Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10366contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10367a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10368will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10369arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
a4ce9883 10370converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
09e881c9
BE
10371@end deftypefn
10372
6626f970
RH
10373@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10374Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10375address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10376@end deftypefn
10377
b6fd8800 10378@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
09e881c9
BE
10379Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10380@var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10381space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10382to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10383guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10384as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10385@end deftypefn
10386
f736b911
RH
10387@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10388Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10389The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10390@end deftypefn
10391
feca2ed3
JW
10392@node Misc
10393@section Miscellaneous Parameters
10394@cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10395
10396@c prevent bad page break with this line
10397Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10398
e543e219
ZW
10399@defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10400Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10401has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10402conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10403blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10404set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10405to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10406@end defmac
10407
10408@defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10409Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10410has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10411conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10412blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10413set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10414to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
a2c4f8e0 10415@end defmac
8fe0ca0c 10416
a2c4f8e0 10417@defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
feca2ed3
JW
10418An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10419elements of a jump-table should have.
a2c4f8e0 10420@end defmac
feca2ed3 10421
a2c4f8e0 10422@defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
33f7f353
JR
10423Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10424when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10425it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
4226378a 10426To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
33f7f353 10427make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
391aaa6b 10428The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
33f7f353 10429flags can be updated.
a2c4f8e0 10430@end defmac
33f7f353 10431
a2c4f8e0 10432@defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
18543a22 10433Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
9c49953c
KH
10434should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10435jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10436contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10437is in effect.
a2c4f8e0 10438@end defmac
feca2ed3 10439
b6fd8800 10440@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
e6ff3083 10441This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
feca2ed3
JW
10442is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10443The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10444five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
e6ff3083 10445@end deftypefn
feca2ed3 10446
a2c4f8e0 10447@defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
9e11bfef 10448Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
feca2ed3
JW
10449smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10450Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
a2c4f8e0 10451@end defmac
feca2ed3 10452
7be4d808 10453@defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
feca2ed3 10454Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
7be4d808
R
10455memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10456bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
feca2ed3 10457zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
7be4d808 10458of @var{mem_mode} for which the
feca2ed3 10459insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
f822d252 10460@code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
feca2ed3 10461
7be4d808 10462This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
feca2ed3
JW
10463greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10464value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
f822d252 10465@code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
feca2ed3 10466define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
7be4d808 10467
f822d252 10468You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
7be4d808
R
10469the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10470of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10471when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10472integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10473
f822d252 10474You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
7be4d808
R
10475mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10476@code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10477is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
a2c4f8e0 10478@end defmac
feca2ed3 10479
a2c4f8e0 10480@defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
58f2ae18 10481Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
77643ab8 10482extends.
a2c4f8e0 10483@end defmac
77643ab8 10484
ef4bddc2 10485@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
bc23502b
PB
10486When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10487divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10488the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10489that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10490of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10491has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10492@end deftypefn
10493
a2c4f8e0 10494@defmac MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10495The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10496between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
a2c4f8e0 10497@end defmac
feca2ed3 10498
a2c4f8e0 10499@defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
feca2ed3
JW
10500The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10501between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10502is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10503constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10504at run-time.
a2c4f8e0 10505@end defmac
feca2ed3 10506
a2c4f8e0 10507@defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
feca2ed3
JW
10508A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10509actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10510of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
df2a54e9 10511this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
feca2ed3
JW
10512a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10513truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
c771326b 10514instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
feca2ed3
JW
10515include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10516also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
c771326b 10517arguments to bit-field instructions.
feca2ed3
JW
10518
10519If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
c771326b 10520position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
feca2ed3
JW
10521instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10522
10523However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10524only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
c771326b 10525bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
feca2ed3
JW
10526such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10527the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10528
10529You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
a2c4f8e0 10530@end defmac
feca2ed3 10531
273a2526 10532@anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
ef4bddc2 10533@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
273a2526
RS
10534This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10535deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10536@xref{shift patterns}.
10537
10538On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10539shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10540equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10541this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10542otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10543particular behavior is guaranteed.
10544
10545Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10546@emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10547that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10548
10549The default implementation of this function returns
10550@code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10551and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10552@code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10553nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10554by overriding it.
10555@end deftypefn
10556
a2c4f8e0 10557@defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
feca2ed3
JW
10558A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10559``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10560bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10561operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10562
10563On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10564
10565@c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10566@c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10567When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10568modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10569If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10570such cases may improve things.
a2c4f8e0 10571@end defmac
feca2ed3 10572
ef4bddc2 10573@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
66a4ad37 10574The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
b12cbf2c
AN
10575are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10576@code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10577sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10578otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10579representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10580@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10581@code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
914d25dc 10582@var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
b12cbf2c
AN
10583widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10584
10585Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10586value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10587as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10588@code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10589
10590Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10591describe two related properties. If you define
10592@code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10593to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10594extension.
10595
10596In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10597@code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10598@code{mode}.
10599@end deftypefn
10600
a2c4f8e0 10601@defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
feca2ed3
JW
10602A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10603with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
ac5eda13
PB
10604(@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10605apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
feca2ed3
JW
10606comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10607
630d3d5a
JM
10608A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10609comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
feca2ed3
JW
10610and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10611which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10612true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10613operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
ac5eda13 10614@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
feca2ed3
JW
10615@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10616the compiler.
10617
630d3d5a 10618If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
feca2ed3
JW
10619generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10620replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10621the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10622For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10623@code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10624@samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10625expression
10626
10627@smallexample
10628(ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10629@end smallexample
10630
10631@noindent
10632can be converted to
10633
10634@smallexample
10635(ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10636@end smallexample
10637
10638@noindent
10639where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10640tested into the sign bit.
10641
10642There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10643for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10644but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
a3a15b4d 10645are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
feca2ed3 10646perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
b11cc610 10647comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
feca2ed3
JW
10648
10649Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10650from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10651choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10652to be used:
10653
10654@itemize @bullet
10655@item
10656Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10657@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10658``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10659comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10660combine the normalization with other operations.
10661
10662@item
630d3d5a 10663For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
feca2ed3
JW
10664slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10665other machines.
10666
10667@item
10668As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10669exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10670others.
10671
10672@item
10673Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10674@end itemize
10675
10676Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10677@code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10678instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10679those cases, e.g., one matching
10680
10681@smallexample
10682(set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10683@end smallexample
10684
10685Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10686condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
ac5eda13 10687@samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
feca2ed3
JW
10688machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10689and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10690@code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
2b0d3573 10691@file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
feca2ed3
JW
10692find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10693
06f31100
RS
10694If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10695not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10696instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
a2c4f8e0 10697@end defmac
feca2ed3 10698
a2c4f8e0 10699@defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
df2a54e9 10700A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
feca2ed3 10701returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
fc7ca5fd 10702Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
feca2ed3
JW
10703floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10704this macro.
a2c4f8e0 10705@end defmac
feca2ed3 10706
fc7ca5fd 10707@defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
a4d05547 10708A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
fc7ca5fd
RS
10709for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10710mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10711this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10712return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10713this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10714@code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10715the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10716given mode.
10717@end defmac
10718
a2c4f8e0
ZW
10719@defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10720@defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
14670a74 10721A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
ff2ce160 10722for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
14670a74
SL
10723A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10724If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10725evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10726entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
ff2ce160 10727the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
14670a74 10728In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
ff2ce160 10729this value.
14670a74
SL
10730
10731If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10732@code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
7dba8395
RH
10733
10734This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10735relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
14670a74
SL
10736is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10737to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
7dba8395
RH
10738
10739Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10740and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10741visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10742to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
8a36672b 10743breaking the API@.
a2c4f8e0 10744@end defmac
7dba8395 10745
a2c4f8e0 10746@defmac Pmode
feca2ed3
JW
10747An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10748this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10749pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10750On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10751modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10752
10753The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10754@code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10755@code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10756to @code{Pmode}.
a2c4f8e0 10757@end defmac
feca2ed3 10758
a2c4f8e0 10759@defmac FUNCTION_MODE
feca2ed3 10760An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
f71e957e 10761being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
ff2ce160 10762where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
f71e957e
DK
10763@code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10764size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10765as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
a2c4f8e0 10766@end defmac
feca2ed3 10767
a2c4f8e0 10768@defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
ee773fcc
NB
10769In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10770constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10771hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10772where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10773strict conformance to the C Standard.
10774
10775Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10776convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10777files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
a2c4f8e0 10778@end defmac
ee773fcc 10779
1efcb8c6
JM
10780@deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10781Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10782
10783 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10784@end deftypefn
10785
88b0e79e
JC
10786@deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10787Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10788@end deftypefn
10789
a2c4f8e0 10790@defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
161d7b59 10791Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
feca2ed3
JW
10792This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10793C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10794@samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
a2c4f8e0 10795@end defmac
feca2ed3 10796
feca2ed3
JW
10797@findex #pragma
10798@findex pragma
a2c4f8e0 10799@defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
8b97c5f8 10800Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
a5da89c6 10801If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
b5b3e36a
DJ
10802@code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10803for each pragma. The macro may also do any
a5da89c6 10804setup required for the pragmas.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10805
10806The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10807other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
161d7b59 10808definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
feca2ed3 10809
c237e94a 10810If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
91d231cb 10811defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
f09db6e0 10812
8b97c5f8
ZW
10813Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10814@samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
630d3d5a 10815silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
a2c4f8e0 10816@end defmac
8b97c5f8 10817
c58b209a 10818@deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
b5b3e36a 10819@deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
8b97c5f8 10820
b5b3e36a
DJ
10821Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10822@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
8b97c5f8
ZW
10823@var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10824pragma of the form
10825
10826@smallexample
10827#pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10828@end smallexample
10829
a5da89c6
NB
10830@var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10831@code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10832routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
51fabca5 10833on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
75ce3d48 10834@var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
51fabca5 10835callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
b5b3e36a
DJ
10836a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10837arguments of pragmas registered with
10838@code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10839pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
8b97c5f8 10840
75ce3d48 10841Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
aac69a49 10842compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
75ce3d48 10843other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
aac69a49 10844to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
c771326b 10845building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
aac69a49 10846variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
aee96fe9 10847target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
aac69a49 10848the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
75ce3d48 10849code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
aac69a49
NC
10850rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10851how to build this object file.
8b97c5f8
ZW
10852@end deftypefun
10853
b5b3e36a 10854@defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
24a57808 10855Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
b5b3e36a
DJ
10856arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10857@end defmac
10858
467cecf3
JB
10859@defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10860If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
0bdcd332 10861the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
8b7d4300 10862This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
467cecf3
JB
10863@samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10864@end defmac
10865
a2c4f8e0 10866@defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
b1822ccc 10867Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
170ea7b9 10868identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
b1822ccc
NB
10869not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10870there is no need to define this macro in that case.
a2c4f8e0 10871@end defmac
feca2ed3 10872
a2c4f8e0 10873@defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10874Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10875delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10876even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
a3a15b4d 10877@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
feca2ed3
JW
10878every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10879or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10880you should define this macro.
10881
10882You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10883@end defmac
feca2ed3 10884
a2c4f8e0 10885@defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
feca2ed3
JW
10886Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10887delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10888even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10889@var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10890some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10891are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10892define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10893instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10894slot of @var{insn}.
10895
10896You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
a2c4f8e0 10897@end defmac
feca2ed3 10898
a2c4f8e0 10899@defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
15072eb1
ZW
10900Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10901global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10902symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10903instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10904from shared libraries (DLLs).
10905
10906You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
a2c4f8e0 10907@end defmac
861bb6c1 10908
7ca35180
RH
10909@deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
10910This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
10911@var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
10912clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
10913to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
10914
10915It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
10916as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
10917a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
67dfe110 10918@end deftypefn
57bcb97a 10919
a2c4f8e0 10920@defmac MATH_LIBRARY
71d718e0 10921Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
d9d16a19
JM
10922in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10923@samp{""} if the target does not have a
71d718e0
JM
10924separate math library.
10925
d9d16a19 10926You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10927@end defmac
512b62fb 10928
a2c4f8e0 10929@defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
512b62fb
JM
10930Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10931specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10932
10933You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10934is wrong.
a2c4f8e0 10935@end defmac
e09d24ff 10936
4969c0d8
L
10937@defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10938Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10939functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10940Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
e09d24ff 10941to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
4969c0d8 10942if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
709a840a 10943for cross-profiling.
a2c4f8e0 10944@end defmac
0c99ec5c 10945
a2c4f8e0 10946@defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
0c99ec5c
RH
10947
10948A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10949conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10950@code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
109511 if it does use cc0.
a2c4f8e0 10952@end defmac
90280148 10953
a2c4f8e0 10954@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10955Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10956conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10957@var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10958contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10959and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10960then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10961@var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
a2c4f8e0 10962@end defmac
c05ffc49 10963
a2c4f8e0 10964@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
c05ffc49
BS
10965Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10966if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10967@var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10968being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
a2c4f8e0 10969@end defmac
90280148 10970
a2c4f8e0 10971@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
c05ffc49
BS
10972A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10973be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10974a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10975about the currently processed blocks.
a2c4f8e0 10976@end defmac
90280148 10977
a2c4f8e0 10978@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10979A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10980converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10981can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10982to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10983@end defmac
90280148 10984
a2c4f8e0 10985@defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
90280148 10986A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
c05ffc49
BS
10987converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10988can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10989to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10990@end defmac
c05ffc49 10991
67a0732f
SB
10992@defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
10993A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
10994of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10995to by @var{ce_info}.
a2c4f8e0 10996@end defmac
c05ffc49 10997
b6fd8800 10998@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
18dbd950
RS
10999If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11000instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11001just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11002
11003The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11004it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11005laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11006Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11007
11008You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11009definition is null.
11010@end deftypefn
11011
b6fd8800 11012@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
f6155fda
SS
11013Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11014that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
4a1d48f6
BS
11015necessary setup.
11016
c771326b 11017Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
4a1d48f6
BS
11018instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11019they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11020instructions or prefetch instructions).
11021
6e34d3a3
JM
11022To create a built-in function, call the function
11023@code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
c771326b 11024which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
1a072294 11025up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
c237e94a 11026only language front ends that use those two functions will call
f6155fda 11027@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
acdcefcc 11028@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 11029
914d25dc 11030@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
e9e4b3a8
RG
11031Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11032that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11033builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11034If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11035if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11036If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11037@code{error_mark_node}.
11038@end deftypefn
11039
ef4bddc2 11040@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
4a1d48f6 11041
c771326b 11042Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
f6155fda
SS
11043@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11044function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11045convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11046@var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11047@var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11048ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11049built-in function.
acdcefcc 11050@end deftypefn
4a1d48f6 11051
d5e254e1
IE
11052@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11053This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11054Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11055fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11056passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11057obtained using this hook:
11058@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11059Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11060by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11061bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11062@end deftypefn
11063
11064@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11065Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11066by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11067when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11068@end deftypefn
11069
11070@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11071Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11072by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11073address @var{loc}.
11074@end deftypefn
11075
11076@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11077Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11078by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11079lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11080@end deftypefn
11081
11082@deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11083Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11084by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11085upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11086@end deftypefn
11087
11088@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11089Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11090by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11091@var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11092@end deftypefn
11093
11094@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11095Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11096returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11097@end deftypefn
11098
11099@deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11100Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11101returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11102[@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11103@end deftypefn
11104
11105@deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11106Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11107returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11108@code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11109Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11110(e.g. object has incomplete type).
11111@end deftypefn
11112
11113@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11114Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11115returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11116@end deftypefn
11117
11118@deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11119Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11120returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11121@end deftypefn
11122@end deftypefn
11123@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11124Return type to be used for bounds
11125@end deftypefn
11126@deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11127Return mode to be used for bounds.
11128@end deftypefn
11129@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11130Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11131with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11132@end deftypefn
11133@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11134Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11135bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11136the number of generated statements.
11137@end deftypefn
11138
7a241624 11139@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
4268e4cf
PB
11140Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11141was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11142@emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11143implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11144declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11145arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11146complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11147another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
7a241624 11148@var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
4268e4cf
PB
11149@end deftypefn
11150
f311c3b4 11151@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
a05a80fc
KH
11152Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11153@samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
f311c3b4
NF
11154built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11155the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
ea679d55
JG
11156The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11157containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11158@var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11159@end deftypefn
11160
11161@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11162Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11163by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11164statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11165was made to the GIMPLE stream.
d6c2b67d
PB
11166@end deftypefn
11167
3649b9b7
ST
11168@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11169This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11170determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11171during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11172versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11173is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11174 the two function decls that will be compared.
11175@end deftypefn
11176
11177@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11178This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11179versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11180version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11181identical versions.
11182@end deftypefn
11183
11184@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11185This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11186function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11187@var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11188body must be generated.
11189@end deftypefn
11190
807e902e 11191@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
1d0216c8
RS
11192Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11193and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11194exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11195the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11196the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11197contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11198loop is only entered from the top.
11199
11200This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11201implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11202if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11203@end deftypefn
11204
ac44248e 11205@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
a71a498d 11206
e7e64a25 11207Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
72392b81
JR
11208low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11209could not be applied.
a71a498d 11210
e7e64a25
AS
11211Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11212instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
083cad55 11213the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
a71a498d 11214By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
083cad55 11215loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
a71a498d
AS
11216@end deftypefn
11217
ac44248e 11218@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
78e4f1ad
UB
11219Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11220@end deftypefn
11221
c1ce59ab 11222@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
4b4de898
JR
11223FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11224@end deftypefn
11225
914d25dc 11226@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
8ddf681a
R
11227This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11228Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
0ee2ea09 11229PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
8ddf681a
R
11230of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11231@end deftypefn
11232
b48f503c 11233@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
385b6e2d
R
11234
11235When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
4fe9b91c 11236register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
385b6e2d 11237to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
b48f503c
KK
11238it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11239is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11240that had its initial value copied by using
385b6e2d
R
11241@code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11242Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11243to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11244the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11245@code{MEM}.
11246If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11247it might decide to use another register anyways.
29454ff5
SL
11248You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11249@code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
385b6e2d 11250register in question will not be clobbered.
b48f503c
KK
11251The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11252allocation.
11253@end deftypefn
385b6e2d 11254
215b063c
PB
11255@deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11256This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11257@code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11258this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11259@code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11260to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11261passed along.
11262@end deftypefn
11263
db2960f4 11264@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
ff2ce160 11265The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
db2960f4
SL
11266context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11267the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11268per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11269attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11270The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11271and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11272and is returning to processing at the top level.
11273The default hook function does nothing.
11274
11275GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11276some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11277situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11278or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
914d25dc
JR
11279@code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11280outside of any function scope.
db2960f4
SL
11281@end deftypefn
11282
a2c4f8e0 11283@defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11284Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11285files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11286use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
a2c4f8e0 11287@end defmac
807633e5 11288
a2c4f8e0 11289@defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
807633e5
ZW
11290Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11291automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11292do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11293executable files.
a2c4f8e0 11294@end defmac
807633e5 11295
a2c4f8e0 11296@defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
807633e5
ZW
11297If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11298specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11299Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11300object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11301lists.
a2c4f8e0 11302@end defmac
807633e5 11303
a2c4f8e0 11304@defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
55ae46b1
RM
11305Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11306method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11307must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
95fef11f 11308For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
55ae46b1
RM
11309the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11310defined as this expression:
11311
11312@smallexample
11313build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11314 build_tree_list
11315 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11316 NULL))
11317@end smallexample
a2c4f8e0 11318@end defmac
e4ec2cac
AO
11319
11320@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11321This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11322instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11323every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11324reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11325
11326@smallexample
11327static bool
11328cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11329@{
11330 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11331@}
11332@end smallexample
11333@end deftypefn
fe3ad572 11334
a87cf97e 11335@deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
fe3ad572
SC
11336This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11337optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
c0cbdbd9 11338usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
fe3ad572
SC
11339re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11340to inter-block scheduling.
11341@end deftypefn
11342
11343@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11344Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11345registers
11346that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11347returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11348that all target registers in the class returned by
11349@samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11350saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11351epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11352true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11353to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11354to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11355@end deftypefn
2082e02f 11356
2929029c
WG
11357@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11358This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11359This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11360modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11361@end deftypefn
11362
5f3bc026
ZC
11363@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11364This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11365 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns a appropriate @code{CC}
11366 for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. The insns to
11367 prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare insns are
11368 saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the compares in the
11369 the conditional comparision are generated without error. @var{code} is
2e0f1341
ZC
11370 the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11371@end deftypefn
11372
5f3bc026
ZC
11373@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11374This function prepare to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence of
11375 conditional comparisons. It returns a appropriate @code{CC} for passing to
11376 @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. The insns to prepare the
11377 compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare insns are saved in
11378 @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the compares in the conditional
11379 comparision are generated without error. The @var{prev} expression is the
11380 result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first} or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It
11381 may return @code{NULL} if the combination of @var{prev} and this comparison is
2e0f1341
ZC
11382 not supported, otherwise the result must be appropriate for passing to
11383 @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}. @var{code} is the
11384 @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}. @var{bit_code}
11385 is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the two compares.
11386@end deftypefn
11387
40ac4f73
CB
11388@deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11389This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11390should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11391the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11392the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11393is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11394number of memory accesses.
11395@end deftypefn
11396
2082e02f 11397@defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
73774972 11398If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
2082e02f
RS
11399that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11400that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11401constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11402more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11403system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11404The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11405@end defmac
94d1613b 11406
3dd53121 11407@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
94d1613b
MS
11408This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11409target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
3dd53121
AP
11410are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11411The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11412@end deftypefn
11413
11414@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11415This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11416target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11417indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11418@var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11419@var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
94d1613b
MS
11420@end deftypefn
11421
11422@deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11423This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11424The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11425systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11426that are different from @option{-I}.
11427@end deftypefn
4a77e08c 11428
914d25dc
JR
11429@defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11430This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
4a77e08c 11431for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
914d25dc 11432@code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
431ae0bf 11433functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
4a77e08c 11434@code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
914d25dc 11435@end defmac
a2bec818
DJ
11436
11437@defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11438If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11439target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11440option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11441@end defmac
11442
11443@defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11444If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11445@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11446@end defmac
e50e6b88 11447
6590fc9f
KT
11448@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11449If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11450target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11451default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11452@code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11453@end defmac
11454
11455@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11456If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11457@code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11458@end defmac
11459
94564826
KT
11460@defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11461If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11462routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11463and scanf formatter settings.
11464@end defmac
11465
b6fd8800 11466@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
083cad55
EC
11467If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11468illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
4d3e6fae
FJ
11469with prototype @var{typelist}.
11470@end deftypefn
11471
b6fd8800 11472@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
4de67c26
JM
11473If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11474invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11475if validity should be determined by the front end.
11476@end deftypefn
11477
b6fd8800 11478@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
4de67c26
JM
11479If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11480invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11481@code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11482if validity should be determined by the front end.
11483@end deftypefn
11484
b6fd8800 11485@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
4de67c26
JM
11486If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11487invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11488and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11489the front end.
11490@end deftypefn
11491
b6fd8800 11492@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11493If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11494invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11495or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11496the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11497@end deftypefn
11498
b6fd8800 11499@deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
40449a90 11500If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
ff2ce160 11501invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
40449a90
SL
11502or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11503the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11504@end deftypefn
11505
b6fd8800 11506@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
ff2ce160
MS
11507If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11508@var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
40449a90
SL
11509analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11510front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11511target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11512This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11513@end deftypefn
11514
b6fd8800 11515@deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
ff2ce160
MS
11516If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11517@var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
40449a90 11518or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
ff2ce160 11519This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
40449a90
SL
11520conversion rules.
11521This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11522@end deftypefn
11523
e50e6b88
DS
11524@defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11525This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11526classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11527SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11528@end defmac
64ee9490
EC
11529
11530@defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11531This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11532NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11533@end defmac
56e449d3
SL
11534
11535@defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11536Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
ff2ce160 11537to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
56e449d3
SL
11538call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11539and the associated definitions of those functions.
11540@end defmac
007e61c2 11541
2e3f842f
L
11542@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11543Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11544necessary.
11545@end deftypefn
11546
11547@deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
914d25dc 11548This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
2e3f842f 11549different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
914d25dc
JR
11550argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11551is needed.
2e3f842f
L
11552@end deftypefn
11553
b6fd8800 11554@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
007e61c2
PB
11555When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11556arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11557stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11558debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11559@code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11560cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11561to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11562false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11563@end deftypefn
2c5bfdf7 11564
2c5bfdf7
AN
11565@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11566On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11567a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11568is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11569is computed from this register using immediate addition or
a4ce9883 11570subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
2c5bfdf7
AN
11571the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11572available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11573constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11574down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11575@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11576accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11577value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11578MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11579@code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
0d8aa4b1
AS
11580is zero, which disables this optimization.
11581@end deftypevr
57c5ab1b 11582
dfe06d3e
JJ
11583@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11584Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11585Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11586supported by the target.
11587@end deftypefn
11588
5dcfdccd
KY
11589@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11590Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11591memory model bits are allowed.
11592@end deftypefn
11593
57c5ab1b
RH
11594@deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11595This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11596@end deftypevr
2f251a05
AI
11597
11598@deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11599It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11600The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11601The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11602@end deftypefn
267bac10 11603
ef4bddc2 11604@deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
fceec4d3
AM
11605If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11606@end deftypefn
11607
267bac10
JM
11608@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11609ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11610@end deftypefn
807e902e 11611
ec6fe917
IV
11612@deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11613Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11614sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11615recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11616@end deftypefn
11617
c713ddc0
BS
11618@deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11619Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11620translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11621into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11622to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11623separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11624
11625@end deftypefn
11626
807e902e
KZ
11627@defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11628
11629On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11630objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11631to indicate that large integers are stored in
11632@code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11633very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11634is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11635representation.
11636
11637Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11638@code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11639code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11640const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11641need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11642
11643@itemize @bullet
11644@item
11645There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11646@code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11647language since there are a variable number of elements.
11648
11649Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11650value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11651since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11652are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11653instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11654However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11655code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11656not really a large change.
11657
11658@item
11659Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11660constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11661port in this code.
11662
11663@item
11664The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11665constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11666@end itemize
11667
11668All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11669maintainer is familiar with.
11670
11671@end defmac